You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

17768 lines
474KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program.
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  173. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  174. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  175. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  176. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  177. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  178. @end example
  179. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  180. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  181. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  182. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  183. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  184. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  185. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  186. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  187. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  188. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  189. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  190. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  191. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  192. characters contained within it.
  193. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  194. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  195. @example
  196. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  197. @end example
  198. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  199. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  200. @example
  201. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  202. @end example
  203. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  204. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  205. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  206. @example
  207. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  208. @end example
  209. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  210. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  211. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  212. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  213. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  214. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  215. previous string will finally result in:
  216. @example
  217. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  218. @end example
  219. @chapter Timeline editing
  220. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  221. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  222. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  223. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  224. next filter in the filtergraph.
  225. The expression accepts the following values:
  226. @table @samp
  227. @item t
  228. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  229. @item n
  230. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  231. @item pos
  232. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  233. @item w
  234. @item h
  235. width and height of the input frame if video
  236. @end table
  237. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  238. to re-define the expression.
  239. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  240. rules.
  241. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  242. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  243. @example
  244. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  245. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  246. @end example
  247. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  248. @chapter Audio Filters
  249. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  250. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  251. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  252. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  253. build.
  254. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  255. @section acompressor
  256. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  257. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  258. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  259. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  260. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  261. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  262. but can also destroy a track completely).
  263. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  264. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  265. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  266. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  267. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  268. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  269. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  270. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  271. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  272. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  273. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  274. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  275. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  276. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  277. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  278. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  279. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  280. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  281. The filter accepts the following options:
  282. @table @option
  283. @item level_in
  284. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  285. @item threshold
  286. If a signal of second stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  287. reduction of the first stream.
  288. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  289. @item ratio
  290. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  291. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  292. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  293. @item attack
  294. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  295. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  296. @item release
  297. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  298. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  299. @item makeup
  300. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  301. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  302. @item knee
  303. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  304. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  305. @item link
  306. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  307. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  308. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  309. @item detection
  310. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  311. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  312. @item mix
  313. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  314. Range is between 0 and 1.
  315. @end table
  316. @section acrossfade
  317. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  318. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  319. The filter accepts the following options:
  320. @table @option
  321. @item nb_samples, ns
  322. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  323. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  324. silent. Default is 44100.
  325. @item duration, d
  326. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  327. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  328. for the accepted syntax.
  329. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  330. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  331. @item overlap, o
  332. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  333. @item curve1
  334. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  335. @item curve2
  336. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  337. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  338. @end table
  339. @subsection Examples
  340. @itemize
  341. @item
  342. Cross fade from one input to another:
  343. @example
  344. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  345. @end example
  346. @item
  347. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  348. @example
  349. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  350. @end example
  351. @end itemize
  352. @section acrusher
  353. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  354. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  355. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  356. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  357. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  358. This filter is able to even round to continous values instead of discrete
  359. bit depths.
  360. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  361. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  362. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  363. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  364. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  365. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  366. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception, too
  367. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  368. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  369. The filter accepts the following options:
  370. @table @option
  371. @item level_in
  372. Set level in.
  373. @item level_out
  374. Set level out.
  375. @item bits
  376. Set bit reduction.
  377. @item mix
  378. Set mixing ammount.
  379. @item mode
  380. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  381. @item dc
  382. Set DC.
  383. @item aa
  384. Set anti-aliasing.
  385. @item samples
  386. Set sample reduction.
  387. @item lfo
  388. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  389. @item lforange
  390. Set LFO range.
  391. @item lforate
  392. Set LFO rate.
  393. @end table
  394. @section adelay
  395. Delay one or more audio channels.
  396. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  397. The filter accepts the following option:
  398. @table @option
  399. @item delays
  400. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  401. At least one delay greater than 0 should be provided.
  402. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  403. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  404. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  405. @end table
  406. @subsection Examples
  407. @itemize
  408. @item
  409. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  410. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  411. @example
  412. adelay=1500|0|500
  413. @end example
  414. @item
  415. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  416. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  417. @example
  418. adelay=0|500S|700S
  419. @end example
  420. @end itemize
  421. @section aecho
  422. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  423. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  424. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  425. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  426. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  427. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  428. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  429. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  430. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  431. @table @option
  432. @item in_gain
  433. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  434. @item out_gain
  435. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  436. @item delays
  437. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  438. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  439. Default is @code{1000}.
  440. @item decays
  441. Set list of loudnesses of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  442. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  443. Default is @code{0.5}.
  444. @end table
  445. @subsection Examples
  446. @itemize
  447. @item
  448. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  449. @example
  450. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  451. @end example
  452. @item
  453. If delay is very short, then it sound like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  454. @example
  455. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  456. @end example
  457. @item
  458. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  459. @example
  460. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  461. @end example
  462. @item
  463. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  464. @example
  465. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  466. @end example
  467. @end itemize
  468. @section aemphasis
  469. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  470. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  471. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  472. this recording medium.
  473. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  474. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  475. The filter accepts the following options:
  476. @table @option
  477. @item level_in
  478. Set input gain.
  479. @item level_out
  480. Set output gain.
  481. @item mode
  482. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  483. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  484. @item type
  485. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  486. @table @option
  487. @item col
  488. select Columbia.
  489. @item emi
  490. select EMI.
  491. @item bsi
  492. select BSI (78RPM).
  493. @item riaa
  494. select RIAA.
  495. @item cd
  496. select Compact Disc (CD).
  497. @item 50fm
  498. select 50µs (FM).
  499. @item 75fm
  500. select 75µs (FM).
  501. @item 50kf
  502. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  503. @item 75kf
  504. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  505. @end table
  506. @end table
  507. @section aeval
  508. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  509. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  510. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  511. It accepts the following parameters:
  512. @table @option
  513. @item exprs
  514. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  515. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  516. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  517. output channels.
  518. @item channel_layout, c
  519. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  520. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  521. use by default the same input channel layout.
  522. @end table
  523. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  524. @table @option
  525. @item ch
  526. channel number of the current expression
  527. @item n
  528. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  529. @item s
  530. sample rate
  531. @item t
  532. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  533. @item nb_in_channels
  534. @item nb_out_channels
  535. input and output number of channels
  536. @item val(CH)
  537. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  538. @end table
  539. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  540. dedicated filter.
  541. @subsection Examples
  542. @itemize
  543. @item
  544. Half volume:
  545. @example
  546. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  547. @end example
  548. @item
  549. Invert phase of the second channel:
  550. @example
  551. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  552. @end example
  553. @end itemize
  554. @anchor{afade}
  555. @section afade
  556. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  557. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  558. @table @option
  559. @item type, t
  560. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  561. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  562. @item start_sample, ss
  563. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  564. effect. Default is 0.
  565. @item nb_samples, ns
  566. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  567. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  568. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  569. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  570. @item start_time, st
  571. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  572. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  573. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  574. for the accepted syntax.
  575. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  576. @item duration, d
  577. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  578. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  579. for the accepted syntax.
  580. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  581. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  582. the output audio will be silence.
  583. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  584. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  585. @item curve
  586. Set curve for fade transition.
  587. It accepts the following values:
  588. @table @option
  589. @item tri
  590. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  591. @item qsin
  592. select quarter of sine wave
  593. @item hsin
  594. select half of sine wave
  595. @item esin
  596. select exponential sine wave
  597. @item log
  598. select logarithmic
  599. @item ipar
  600. select inverted parabola
  601. @item qua
  602. select quadratic
  603. @item cub
  604. select cubic
  605. @item squ
  606. select square root
  607. @item cbr
  608. select cubic root
  609. @item par
  610. select parabola
  611. @item exp
  612. select exponential
  613. @item iqsin
  614. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  615. @item ihsin
  616. select inverted half of sine wave
  617. @item dese
  618. select double-exponential seat
  619. @item desi
  620. select double-exponential sigmoid
  621. @end table
  622. @end table
  623. @subsection Examples
  624. @itemize
  625. @item
  626. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  627. @example
  628. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  629. @end example
  630. @item
  631. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  632. @example
  633. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  634. @end example
  635. @end itemize
  636. @section afftfilt
  637. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  638. @table @option
  639. @item real
  640. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  641. by '|'. Default is "1".
  642. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  643. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  644. output channels.
  645. @item imag
  646. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  647. separated by '|'. If not set, @var{real} option is used.
  648. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  649. constants:
  650. @table @option
  651. @item sr
  652. sample rate
  653. @item b
  654. current frequency bin number
  655. @item nb
  656. number of available bins
  657. @item ch
  658. channel number of the current expression
  659. @item chs
  660. number of channels
  661. @item pts
  662. current frame pts
  663. @end table
  664. @item win_size
  665. Set window size.
  666. It accepts the following values:
  667. @table @samp
  668. @item w16
  669. @item w32
  670. @item w64
  671. @item w128
  672. @item w256
  673. @item w512
  674. @item w1024
  675. @item w2048
  676. @item w4096
  677. @item w8192
  678. @item w16384
  679. @item w32768
  680. @item w65536
  681. @end table
  682. Default is @code{w4096}
  683. @item win_func
  684. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  685. @item overlap
  686. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  687. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  688. @end table
  689. @subsection Examples
  690. @itemize
  691. @item
  692. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  693. @example
  694. afftfilt="1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1)"
  695. @end example
  696. @end itemize
  697. @anchor{aformat}
  698. @section aformat
  699. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  700. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  701. It accepts the following parameters:
  702. @table @option
  703. @item sample_fmts
  704. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  705. @item sample_rates
  706. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  707. @item channel_layouts
  708. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  709. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  710. for the required syntax.
  711. @end table
  712. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  713. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  714. @example
  715. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  716. @end example
  717. @section agate
  718. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  719. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  720. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  721. and divide it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  722. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  723. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  724. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  725. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  726. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  727. has to raise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  728. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  729. @table @option
  730. @item level_in
  731. Set input level before filtering.
  732. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  733. @item range
  734. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  735. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  736. @item threshold
  737. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  738. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  739. @item ratio
  740. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  741. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  742. @item attack
  743. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  744. reduction stops.
  745. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  746. @item release
  747. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  748. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  749. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  750. @item makeup
  751. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  752. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  753. @item knee
  754. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  755. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  756. @item detection
  757. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  758. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  759. @item link
  760. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  761. the reduction.
  762. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  763. @end table
  764. @section alimiter
  765. The limiter prevents input signal from raising over a desired threshold.
  766. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  767. It means that there is a small delay after signal is processed. Keep in mind
  768. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  769. The filter accepts the following options:
  770. @table @option
  771. @item level_in
  772. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  773. @item level_out
  774. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  775. @item limit
  776. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  777. @item attack
  778. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  779. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  780. @item release
  781. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  782. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  783. @item asc
  784. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  785. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  786. time.
  787. @item asc_level
  788. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  789. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  790. @item level
  791. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  792. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  793. @end table
  794. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  795. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  796. @section allpass
  797. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  798. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  799. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  800. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  801. The filter accepts the following options:
  802. @table @option
  803. @item frequency, f
  804. Set frequency in Hz.
  805. @item width_type
  806. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  807. @table @option
  808. @item h
  809. Hz
  810. @item q
  811. Q-Factor
  812. @item o
  813. octave
  814. @item s
  815. slope
  816. @end table
  817. @item width, w
  818. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  819. @end table
  820. @section aloop
  821. Loop audio samples.
  822. The filter accepts the following options:
  823. @table @option
  824. @item loop
  825. Set the number of loops.
  826. @item size
  827. Set maximal number of samples.
  828. @item start
  829. Set first sample of loop.
  830. @end table
  831. @anchor{amerge}
  832. @section amerge
  833. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  834. The filter accepts the following options:
  835. @table @option
  836. @item inputs
  837. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  838. @end table
  839. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  840. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  841. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  842. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  843. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  844. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  845. channels.
  846. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  847. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  848. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  849. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  850. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  851. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  852. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  853. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  854. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  855. shortest.
  856. @subsection Examples
  857. @itemize
  858. @item
  859. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  860. @example
  861. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  862. @end example
  863. @item
  864. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  865. @example
  866. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  867. @end example
  868. @end itemize
  869. @section amix
  870. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  871. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  872. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  873. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  874. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  875. For example
  876. @example
  877. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  878. @end example
  879. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  880. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  881. It accepts the following parameters:
  882. @table @option
  883. @item inputs
  884. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  885. @item duration
  886. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  887. @table @option
  888. @item longest
  889. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  890. @item shortest
  891. The duration of the shortest input.
  892. @item first
  893. The duration of the first input.
  894. @end table
  895. @item dropout_transition
  896. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  897. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  898. @end table
  899. @section anequalizer
  900. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  901. It accepts the following parameters:
  902. @table @option
  903. @item params
  904. This option string is in format:
  905. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  906. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  907. @table @option
  908. @item chn
  909. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  910. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  911. @item f
  912. Set central frequency for band.
  913. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  914. @item w
  915. Set band width in hertz.
  916. @item g
  917. Set band gain in dB.
  918. @item t
  919. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  920. @table @samp
  921. @item 0
  922. Butterworth, this is default.
  923. @item 1
  924. Chebyshev type 1.
  925. @item 2
  926. Chebyshev type 2.
  927. @end table
  928. @end table
  929. @item curves
  930. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  931. in video stream.
  932. @item size
  933. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  934. @item mgain
  935. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  936. Setting this to reasonable value allows to display gain which is derived from
  937. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  938. when both are activated.
  939. @item fscale
  940. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  941. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  942. @item colors
  943. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  944. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  945. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  946. @end table
  947. @subsection Examples
  948. @itemize
  949. @item
  950. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  951. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  952. @example
  953. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  954. @end example
  955. @end itemize
  956. @subsection Commands
  957. This filter supports the following commands:
  958. @table @option
  959. @item change
  960. Alter existing filter parameters.
  961. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  962. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  963. error is returned.
  964. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  965. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  966. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  967. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  968. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  969. @end table
  970. @section anull
  971. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  972. @section apad
  973. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  974. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  975. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  976. A description of the accepted options follows.
  977. @table @option
  978. @item packet_size
  979. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  980. @item pad_len
  981. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  982. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  983. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  984. @item whole_len
  985. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  986. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  987. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  988. with @option{pad_len}.
  989. @end table
  990. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} option is
  991. set, the filter will add silence to the end of the input stream
  992. indefinitely.
  993. @subsection Examples
  994. @itemize
  995. @item
  996. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  997. @example
  998. apad=pad_len=1024
  999. @end example
  1000. @item
  1001. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1002. the input with silence if required:
  1003. @example
  1004. apad=whole_len=10000
  1005. @end example
  1006. @item
  1007. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1008. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1009. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1010. option:
  1011. @example
  1012. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1013. @end example
  1014. @end itemize
  1015. @section aphaser
  1016. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1017. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1018. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1019. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1020. @table @option
  1021. @item in_gain
  1022. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1023. @item out_gain
  1024. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1025. @item delay
  1026. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1027. @item decay
  1028. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1029. @item speed
  1030. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1031. @item type
  1032. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1033. It accepts the following values:
  1034. @table @samp
  1035. @item triangular, t
  1036. @item sinusoidal, s
  1037. @end table
  1038. @end table
  1039. @section apulsator
  1040. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1041. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1042. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1043. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1044. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1045. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1046. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1047. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1048. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1049. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1050. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1051. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1052. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1053. The filter accepts the following options:
  1054. @table @option
  1055. @item level_in
  1056. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1057. @item level_out
  1058. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1059. @item mode
  1060. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1061. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1062. @item amount
  1063. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1064. @item offset_l
  1065. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1066. @item offset_r
  1067. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1068. @item width
  1069. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1070. @item timing
  1071. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1072. @item bpm
  1073. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1074. is set to bpm.
  1075. @item ms
  1076. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1077. is set to ms.
  1078. @item hz
  1079. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1080. if timing is set to hz.
  1081. @end table
  1082. @anchor{aresample}
  1083. @section aresample
  1084. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1085. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1086. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1087. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1088. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1089. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1090. The filter accepts the syntax
  1091. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1092. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1093. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1094. ffmpeg-resampler manual for the complete list of supported options.
  1095. @subsection Examples
  1096. @itemize
  1097. @item
  1098. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1099. @example
  1100. aresample=44100
  1101. @end example
  1102. @item
  1103. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1104. samples per second compensation:
  1105. @example
  1106. aresample=async=1000
  1107. @end example
  1108. @end itemize
  1109. @section areverse
  1110. Reverse an audio clip.
  1111. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1112. is suggested.
  1113. @subsection Examples
  1114. @itemize
  1115. @item
  1116. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1117. @example
  1118. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1119. @end example
  1120. @end itemize
  1121. @section asetnsamples
  1122. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1123. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1124. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1125. signal its end.
  1126. The filter accepts the following options:
  1127. @table @option
  1128. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1129. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1130. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1131. Default value is 1024.
  1132. @item pad, p
  1133. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1134. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1135. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1136. @end table
  1137. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1138. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1139. @example
  1140. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1141. @end example
  1142. @section asetrate
  1143. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1144. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1145. The filter accepts the following options:
  1146. @table @option
  1147. @item sample_rate, r
  1148. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1149. @end table
  1150. @section ashowinfo
  1151. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1152. The input audio is not modified.
  1153. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1154. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1155. The following values are shown in the output:
  1156. @table @option
  1157. @item n
  1158. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1159. @item pts
  1160. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1161. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1162. @item pts_time
  1163. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1164. @item pos
  1165. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1166. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1167. @item fmt
  1168. The sample format.
  1169. @item chlayout
  1170. The channel layout.
  1171. @item rate
  1172. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1173. @item nb_samples
  1174. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1175. @item checksum
  1176. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1177. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1178. @item plane_checksums
  1179. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1180. @end table
  1181. @anchor{astats}
  1182. @section astats
  1183. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1184. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1185. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1186. It accepts the following option:
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item length
  1189. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1190. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 10]}.
  1191. @item metadata
  1192. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1193. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1194. disabled.
  1195. Available keys for each channel are:
  1196. DC_offset
  1197. Min_level
  1198. Max_level
  1199. Min_difference
  1200. Max_difference
  1201. Mean_difference
  1202. Peak_level
  1203. RMS_peak
  1204. RMS_trough
  1205. Crest_factor
  1206. Flat_factor
  1207. Peak_count
  1208. Bit_depth
  1209. and for Overall:
  1210. DC_offset
  1211. Min_level
  1212. Max_level
  1213. Min_difference
  1214. Max_difference
  1215. Mean_difference
  1216. Peak_level
  1217. RMS_level
  1218. RMS_peak
  1219. RMS_trough
  1220. Flat_factor
  1221. Peak_count
  1222. Bit_depth
  1223. Number_of_samples
  1224. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1225. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1226. For description what each key means read below.
  1227. @item reset
  1228. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1229. Default is disabled.
  1230. @end table
  1231. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1232. @table @option
  1233. @item DC offset
  1234. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1235. @item Min level
  1236. Minimal sample level.
  1237. @item Max level
  1238. Maximal sample level.
  1239. @item Min difference
  1240. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1241. @item Max difference
  1242. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1243. @item Mean difference
  1244. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1245. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1246. @item Peak level dB
  1247. @item RMS level dB
  1248. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1249. @item RMS peak dB
  1250. @item RMS trough dB
  1251. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1252. @item Crest factor
  1253. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1254. @item Flat factor
  1255. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1256. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1257. @item Peak count
  1258. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1259. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1260. @item Bit depth
  1261. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1262. @end table
  1263. @section asyncts
  1264. Synchronize audio data with timestamps by squeezing/stretching it and/or
  1265. dropping samples/adding silence when needed.
  1266. This filter is not built by default, please use @ref{aresample} to do squeezing/stretching.
  1267. It accepts the following parameters:
  1268. @table @option
  1269. @item compensate
  1270. Enable stretching/squeezing the data to make it match the timestamps. Disabled
  1271. by default. When disabled, time gaps are covered with silence.
  1272. @item min_delta
  1273. The minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
  1274. adding/dropping samples. The default value is 0.1. If you get an imperfect
  1275. sync with this filter, try setting this parameter to 0.
  1276. @item max_comp
  1277. The maximum compensation in samples per second. Only relevant with compensate=1.
  1278. The default value is 500.
  1279. @item first_pts
  1280. Assume that the first PTS should be this value. The time base is 1 / sample
  1281. rate. This allows for padding/trimming at the start of the stream. By default,
  1282. no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or
  1283. trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
  1284. silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
  1285. with a negative PTS due to encoder delay.
  1286. @end table
  1287. @section atempo
  1288. Adjust audio tempo.
  1289. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1290. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1291. be in the [0.5, 2.0] range.
  1292. @subsection Examples
  1293. @itemize
  1294. @item
  1295. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1296. @example
  1297. atempo=0.8
  1298. @end example
  1299. @item
  1300. To speed up audio to 125% tempo:
  1301. @example
  1302. atempo=1.25
  1303. @end example
  1304. @end itemize
  1305. @section atrim
  1306. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1307. It accepts the following parameters:
  1308. @table @option
  1309. @item start
  1310. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1311. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1312. @item end
  1313. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1314. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1315. the last sample in the output.
  1316. @item start_pts
  1317. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1318. instead of seconds.
  1319. @item end_pts
  1320. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1321. of seconds.
  1322. @item duration
  1323. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1324. @item start_sample
  1325. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1326. @item end_sample
  1327. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1328. @end table
  1329. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1330. duration specifications; see
  1331. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1332. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1333. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1334. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1335. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1336. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1337. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1338. atrim filter.
  1339. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1340. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1341. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1342. filters.
  1343. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1344. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1345. Examples:
  1346. @itemize
  1347. @item
  1348. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1349. @example
  1350. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1351. @end example
  1352. @item
  1353. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1354. @example
  1355. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1356. @end example
  1357. @end itemize
  1358. @section bandpass
  1359. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1360. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1361. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1362. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1363. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1364. The filter accepts the following options:
  1365. @table @option
  1366. @item frequency, f
  1367. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1368. @item csg
  1369. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1370. @item width_type
  1371. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1372. @table @option
  1373. @item h
  1374. Hz
  1375. @item q
  1376. Q-Factor
  1377. @item o
  1378. octave
  1379. @item s
  1380. slope
  1381. @end table
  1382. @item width, w
  1383. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1384. @end table
  1385. @section bandreject
  1386. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  1387. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  1388. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1389. The filter accepts the following options:
  1390. @table @option
  1391. @item frequency, f
  1392. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1393. @item width_type
  1394. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1395. @table @option
  1396. @item h
  1397. Hz
  1398. @item q
  1399. Q-Factor
  1400. @item o
  1401. octave
  1402. @item s
  1403. slope
  1404. @end table
  1405. @item width, w
  1406. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1407. @end table
  1408. @section bass
  1409. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  1410. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  1411. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  1412. The filter accepts the following options:
  1413. @table @option
  1414. @item gain, g
  1415. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  1416. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  1417. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1418. @item frequency, f
  1419. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  1420. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  1421. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  1422. @item width_type
  1423. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1424. @table @option
  1425. @item h
  1426. Hz
  1427. @item q
  1428. Q-Factor
  1429. @item o
  1430. octave
  1431. @item s
  1432. slope
  1433. @end table
  1434. @item width, w
  1435. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  1436. @end table
  1437. @section biquad
  1438. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  1439. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  1440. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  1441. @section bs2b
  1442. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  1443. stereo audio records.
  1444. It accepts the following parameters:
  1445. @table @option
  1446. @item profile
  1447. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  1448. @table @option
  1449. @item default
  1450. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  1451. @item cmoy
  1452. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  1453. @item jmeier
  1454. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  1455. @end table
  1456. @item fcut
  1457. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  1458. @item feed
  1459. Feed level (in Hz).
  1460. @end table
  1461. @section channelmap
  1462. Remap input channels to new locations.
  1463. It accepts the following parameters:
  1464. @table @option
  1465. @item channel_layout
  1466. The channel layout of the output stream.
  1467. @item map
  1468. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  1469. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  1470. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  1471. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  1472. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  1473. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  1474. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  1475. @end table
  1476. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  1477. output channels, preserving indices.
  1478. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  1479. @example
  1480. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  1481. @end example
  1482. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  1483. the input.
  1484. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  1485. @example
  1486. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  1487. @end example
  1488. @section channelsplit
  1489. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  1490. It accepts the following parameters:
  1491. @table @option
  1492. @item channel_layout
  1493. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  1494. @end table
  1495. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  1496. @example
  1497. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  1498. @end example
  1499. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  1500. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  1501. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  1502. @example
  1503. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  1504. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  1505. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  1506. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  1507. side_right.wav
  1508. @end example
  1509. @section chorus
  1510. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  1511. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  1512. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  1513. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  1514. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  1515. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  1516. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  1517. off key.
  1518. It accepts the following parameters:
  1519. @table @option
  1520. @item in_gain
  1521. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1522. @item out_gain
  1523. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  1524. @item delays
  1525. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  1526. @item decays
  1527. Set decays.
  1528. @item speeds
  1529. Set speeds.
  1530. @item depths
  1531. Set depths.
  1532. @end table
  1533. @subsection Examples
  1534. @itemize
  1535. @item
  1536. A single delay:
  1537. @example
  1538. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  1539. @end example
  1540. @item
  1541. Two delays:
  1542. @example
  1543. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  1544. @end example
  1545. @item
  1546. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  1547. @example
  1548. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  1549. @end example
  1550. @end itemize
  1551. @section compand
  1552. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  1553. It accepts the following parameters:
  1554. @table @option
  1555. @item attacks
  1556. @item decays
  1557. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  1558. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  1559. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  1560. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  1561. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  1562. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  1563. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  1564. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  1565. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  1566. @item points
  1567. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  1568. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  1569. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  1570. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  1571. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  1572. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  1573. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  1574. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20}.
  1575. @item soft-knee
  1576. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  1577. @item gain
  1578. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  1579. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  1580. It defaults to 0.
  1581. @item volume
  1582. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  1583. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  1584. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  1585. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  1586. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  1587. @item delay
  1588. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  1589. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  1590. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  1591. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  1592. @end table
  1593. @subsection Examples
  1594. @itemize
  1595. @item
  1596. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  1597. noisy environment:
  1598. @example
  1599. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  1600. @end example
  1601. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  1602. @example
  1603. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  1604. @end example
  1605. @item
  1606. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  1607. @example
  1608. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  1612. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  1613. @example
  1614. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  1615. @end example
  1616. @item
  1617. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  1618. @example
  1619. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  1620. @end example
  1621. @item
  1622. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  1623. @example
  1624. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  1625. @end example
  1626. @item
  1627. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  1628. @example
  1629. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  1630. @end example
  1631. @item
  1632. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  1633. @example
  1634. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  1635. @end example
  1636. @item
  1637. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  1638. @example
  1639. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  1640. @end example
  1641. @item
  1642. Compressor/Gate:
  1643. @example
  1644. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  1645. @end example
  1646. @item
  1647. Expander:
  1648. @example
  1649. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  1650. @end example
  1651. @item
  1652. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  1653. @example
  1654. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  1655. @end example
  1656. @item
  1657. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  1658. @example
  1659. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  1660. @end example
  1661. @item
  1662. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  1663. @example
  1664. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  1665. @end example
  1666. @item
  1667. Soft limiter:
  1668. @example
  1669. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  1670. @end example
  1671. @end itemize
  1672. @section compensationdelay
  1673. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  1674. positions of microphones or speakers.
  1675. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  1676. different location. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  1677. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  1678. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  1679. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that distance of
  1680. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone to capture signal in
  1681. antiphase to another microphone. That makes the final mix sounding moody.
  1682. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  1683. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  1684. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  1685. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  1686. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  1687. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  1688. It accepts the following parameters:
  1689. @table @option
  1690. @item mm
  1691. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  1692. Default is 0.
  1693. @item cm
  1694. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  1695. Default is 0.
  1696. @item m
  1697. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  1698. Default is 0.
  1699. @item dry
  1700. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  1701. Default is 0.
  1702. @item wet
  1703. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  1704. Default is 1.
  1705. @item temp
  1706. Set temperature degree in Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  1707. Default is 20.
  1708. @end table
  1709. @section crystalizer
  1710. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  1711. The filter accepts the following options:
  1712. @table @option
  1713. @item i
  1714. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  1715. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  1716. @item c
  1717. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  1718. @end table
  1719. @section dcshift
  1720. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  1721. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  1722. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  1723. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  1724. a signal has a DC offset.
  1725. @table @option
  1726. @item shift
  1727. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  1728. the audio.
  1729. @item limitergain
  1730. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  1731. used to prevent clipping.
  1732. @end table
  1733. @section dynaudnorm
  1734. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  1735. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  1736. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  1737. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  1738. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  1739. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  1740. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  1741. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  1742. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  1743. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  1744. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  1745. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  1746. @table @option
  1747. @item f
  1748. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  1749. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  1750. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  1751. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  1752. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  1753. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  1754. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  1755. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  1756. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  1757. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  1758. been found to give good results with most files.
  1759. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  1760. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  1761. @item g
  1762. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  1763. number. Default is 31.
  1764. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  1765. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  1766. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  1767. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  1768. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  1769. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  1770. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  1771. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  1772. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  1773. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1774. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  1775. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  1776. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  1777. @item p
  1778. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  1779. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  1780. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  1781. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  1782. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  1783. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  1784. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  1785. @item m
  1786. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  1787. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  1788. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  1789. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  1790. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  1791. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  1792. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  1793. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  1794. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  1795. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  1796. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  1797. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  1798. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  1799. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  1800. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  1801. value.
  1802. @item r
  1803. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  1804. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  1805. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  1806. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  1807. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  1808. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  1809. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  1810. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  1811. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  1812. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  1813. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  1814. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  1815. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  1816. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  1817. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  1818. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  1819. @item n
  1820. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  1821. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  1822. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  1823. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  1824. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  1825. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  1826. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  1827. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  1828. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  1829. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  1830. @item c
  1831. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  1832. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  1833. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  1834. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  1835. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  1836. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  1837. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  1838. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  1839. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  1840. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  1841. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  1842. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  1843. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  1844. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  1845. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  1846. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  1847. between neighbouring frames.
  1848. @item b
  1849. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  1850. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  1851. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  1852. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  1853. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  1854. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  1855. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  1856. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  1857. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  1858. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  1859. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  1860. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  1861. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  1862. @item s
  1863. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  1864. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  1865. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  1866. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  1867. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  1868. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  1869. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  1870. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  1871. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  1872. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  1873. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  1874. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  1875. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  1876. frame.
  1877. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  1878. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  1879. @end table
  1880. @section earwax
  1881. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  1882. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  1883. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  1884. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  1885. the listener (standard for speakers).
  1886. Ported from SoX.
  1887. @section equalizer
  1888. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  1889. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  1890. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  1891. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  1892. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  1893. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  1894. The filter accepts the following options:
  1895. @table @option
  1896. @item frequency, f
  1897. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  1898. @item width_type
  1899. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1900. @table @option
  1901. @item h
  1902. Hz
  1903. @item q
  1904. Q-Factor
  1905. @item o
  1906. octave
  1907. @item s
  1908. slope
  1909. @end table
  1910. @item width, w
  1911. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1912. @item gain, g
  1913. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  1914. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  1915. @end table
  1916. @subsection Examples
  1917. @itemize
  1918. @item
  1919. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  1920. @example
  1921. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=h:width=200:g=-10
  1922. @end example
  1923. @item
  1924. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  1925. @example
  1926. equalizer=f=1000:width_type=q:width=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:width_type=q:width=2:g=-5
  1927. @end example
  1928. @end itemize
  1929. @section extrastereo
  1930. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  1931. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  1932. The filter accepts the following options:
  1933. @table @option
  1934. @item m
  1935. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  1936. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  1937. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  1938. @item c
  1939. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  1940. @end table
  1941. @section firequalizer
  1942. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  1943. The filter accepts the following option:
  1944. @table @option
  1945. @item gain
  1946. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  1947. @table @option
  1948. @item f
  1949. the evaluated frequency
  1950. @item sr
  1951. sample rate
  1952. @item ch
  1953. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1954. @item chid
  1955. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  1956. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  1957. @item chs
  1958. number of channels
  1959. @item chlayout
  1960. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  1961. @end table
  1962. and functions:
  1963. @table @option
  1964. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  1965. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  1966. @end table
  1967. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  1968. @item gain_entry
  1969. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  1970. contain functions:
  1971. @table @option
  1972. @item entry(f, g)
  1973. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  1974. @end table
  1975. This option is also available as command.
  1976. @item delay
  1977. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  1978. Default is @code{0.01}.
  1979. @item accuracy
  1980. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  1981. Default is @code{5}.
  1982. @item wfunc
  1983. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  1984. @table @option
  1985. @item rectangular
  1986. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  1987. @item hann
  1988. hann window (default)
  1989. @item hamming
  1990. hamming window
  1991. @item blackman
  1992. blackman window
  1993. @item nuttall3
  1994. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1995. @item mnuttall3
  1996. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  1997. @item nuttall
  1998. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  1999. @item bnuttall
  2000. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2001. @item bharris
  2002. blackman-harris window
  2003. @end table
  2004. @item fixed
  2005. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2006. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2007. @item multi
  2008. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2009. @item zero_phase
  2010. Enable zero phase mode by substracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2011. Default is disabled.
  2012. @end table
  2013. @subsection Examples
  2014. @itemize
  2015. @item
  2016. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2017. @example
  2018. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2019. @end example
  2020. @item
  2021. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2022. @example
  2023. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2024. @end example
  2025. @item
  2026. custom equalization:
  2027. @example
  2028. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2029. @end example
  2030. @item
  2031. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2032. @example
  2033. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2034. @end example
  2035. @item
  2036. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2037. @example
  2038. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2039. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2040. @end example
  2041. @end itemize
  2042. @section flanger
  2043. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2044. The filter accepts the following options:
  2045. @table @option
  2046. @item delay
  2047. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2048. @item depth
  2049. Set added swep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2050. @item regen
  2051. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2052. Default value is 0.
  2053. @item width
  2054. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2055. Default value is 71.
  2056. @item speed
  2057. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2058. @item shape
  2059. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2060. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2061. @item phase
  2062. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2063. Default value is 25.
  2064. @item interp
  2065. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2066. Default is @var{linear}.
  2067. @end table
  2068. @section hdcd
  2069. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2070. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2071. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2072. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2073. @example
  2074. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2075. @end example
  2076. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2077. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2078. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2079. @example
  2080. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2081. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -acodec pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2082. @end example
  2083. The filter accepts the following options:
  2084. @table @option
  2085. @item disable_autoconvert
  2086. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2087. @item process_stereo
  2088. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2089. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2090. @item cdt_ms
  2091. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2092. @item force_pe
  2093. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2094. @item analyze_mode
  2095. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2096. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2097. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2098. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  2099. Modes are:
  2100. @table @samp
  2101. @item 0, off
  2102. Disabled
  2103. @item 1, lle
  2104. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  2105. @item 2, pe
  2106. Samples where peak extend occurs
  2107. @item 3, cdt
  2108. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  2109. @item 4, tgm
  2110. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  2111. @end table
  2112. @end table
  2113. @section highpass
  2114. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  2115. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  2116. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  2117. The filter accepts the following options:
  2118. @table @option
  2119. @item frequency, f
  2120. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  2121. @item poles, p
  2122. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  2123. @item width_type
  2124. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2125. @table @option
  2126. @item h
  2127. Hz
  2128. @item q
  2129. Q-Factor
  2130. @item o
  2131. octave
  2132. @item s
  2133. slope
  2134. @end table
  2135. @item width, w
  2136. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2137. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2138. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2139. @end table
  2140. @section join
  2141. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  2142. It accepts the following parameters:
  2143. @table @option
  2144. @item inputs
  2145. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  2146. @item channel_layout
  2147. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  2148. @item map
  2149. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2150. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  2151. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  2152. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  2153. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  2154. channel.
  2155. @end table
  2156. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  2157. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  2158. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  2159. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  2160. @example
  2161. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  2162. @end example
  2163. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  2164. @example
  2165. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  2166. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  2167. out
  2168. @end example
  2169. @section ladspa
  2170. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  2171. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2172. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  2173. @table @option
  2174. @item file, f
  2175. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  2176. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  2177. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  2178. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  2179. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  2180. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  2181. @item plugin, p
  2182. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  2183. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  2184. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  2185. @item controls, c
  2186. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  2187. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  2188. threshold or gain).
  2189. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  2190. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  2191. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2192. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  2193. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  2194. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  2195. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  2196. their valid ranges are printed.
  2197. @item sample_rate, s
  2198. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  2199. zero inputs.
  2200. @item nb_samples, n
  2201. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  2202. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2203. @item duration, d
  2204. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  2205. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  2206. for the accepted syntax.
  2207. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  2208. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  2209. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  2210. supposed to be generated forever.
  2211. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  2212. @end table
  2213. @subsection Examples
  2214. @itemize
  2215. @item
  2216. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  2217. @example
  2218. ladspa=file=amp
  2219. @end example
  2220. @item
  2221. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  2222. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  2223. @example
  2224. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  2225. @end example
  2226. @item
  2227. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  2228. plugin library:
  2229. @example
  2230. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  2231. @end example
  2232. @item
  2233. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  2234. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  2235. @example
  2236. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  2237. @end example
  2238. @item
  2239. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  2240. @example
  2241. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  2242. @end example
  2243. @item
  2244. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  2245. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  2246. @example
  2247. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  2248. @end example
  2249. @item
  2250. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  2251. @example
  2252. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  2253. @end example
  2254. @item
  2255. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  2256. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2257. @example
  2258. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  2259. @end example
  2260. @item
  2261. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  2262. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  2263. @example
  2264. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  2265. @end example
  2266. @end itemize
  2267. @subsection Commands
  2268. This filter supports the following commands:
  2269. @table @option
  2270. @item cN
  2271. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  2272. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  2273. @end table
  2274. @section loudnorm
  2275. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  2276. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  2277. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak.
  2278. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2279. @code{--enable-libebur128}.
  2280. The filter accepts the following options:
  2281. @table @option
  2282. @item I, i
  2283. Set integrated loudness target.
  2284. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  2285. @item LRA, lra
  2286. Set loudness range target.
  2287. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  2288. @item TP, tp
  2289. Set maximum true peak.
  2290. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  2291. @item measured_I, measured_i
  2292. Measured IL of input file.
  2293. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  2294. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  2295. Measured LRA of input file.
  2296. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  2297. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  2298. Measured true peak of input file.
  2299. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  2300. @item measured_thresh
  2301. Measured threshold of input file.
  2302. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  2303. @item offset
  2304. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  2305. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  2306. @item linear
  2307. Normalize linearly if possible.
  2308. measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
  2309. to be specified in order to use this mode.
  2310. Options are true or false. Default is true.
  2311. @item dual_mono
  2312. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  2313. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  2314. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  2315. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  2316. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  2317. @item print_format
  2318. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  2319. Default value is none.
  2320. @end table
  2321. @section lowpass
  2322. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  2323. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  2324. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  2325. The filter accepts the following options:
  2326. @table @option
  2327. @item frequency, f
  2328. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  2329. @item poles, p
  2330. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  2331. @item width_type
  2332. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2333. @table @option
  2334. @item h
  2335. Hz
  2336. @item q
  2337. Q-Factor
  2338. @item o
  2339. octave
  2340. @item s
  2341. slope
  2342. @end table
  2343. @item width, w
  2344. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2345. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  2346. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  2347. @end table
  2348. @anchor{pan}
  2349. @section pan
  2350. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  2351. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  2352. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  2353. stream.
  2354. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  2355. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  2356. @table @option
  2357. @item l
  2358. output channel layout or number of channels
  2359. @item outdef
  2360. output channel specification, of the form:
  2361. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[+[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  2362. @item out_name
  2363. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  2364. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  2365. @item gain
  2366. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  2367. @item in_name
  2368. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  2369. named and numbered input channels
  2370. @end table
  2371. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  2372. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  2373. avoiding clipping noise.
  2374. @subsection Mixing examples
  2375. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  2376. factor for the left channel:
  2377. @example
  2378. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  2379. @end example
  2380. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  2381. 7-channels surround:
  2382. @example
  2383. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  2384. @end example
  2385. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  2386. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  2387. needs.
  2388. @subsection Remapping examples
  2389. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  2390. @itemize
  2391. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  2392. @item only one input per channel output,
  2393. @end itemize
  2394. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  2395. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  2396. remapping.
  2397. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  2398. dropping the extra channels:
  2399. @example
  2400. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  2401. @end example
  2402. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  2403. and keep the input channel layout:
  2404. @example
  2405. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  2406. @end example
  2407. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  2408. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  2409. @example
  2410. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  2411. @end example
  2412. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  2413. front left and right:
  2414. @example
  2415. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  2416. @end example
  2417. @section replaygain
  2418. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  2419. outputs it unchanged.
  2420. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  2421. @section resample
  2422. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  2423. not meant to be used directly.
  2424. @section rubberband
  2425. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  2426. The filter accepts the following options:
  2427. @table @option
  2428. @item tempo
  2429. Set tempo scale factor.
  2430. @item pitch
  2431. Set pitch scale factor.
  2432. @item transients
  2433. Set transients detector.
  2434. Possible values are:
  2435. @table @var
  2436. @item crisp
  2437. @item mixed
  2438. @item smooth
  2439. @end table
  2440. @item detector
  2441. Set detector.
  2442. Possible values are:
  2443. @table @var
  2444. @item compound
  2445. @item percussive
  2446. @item soft
  2447. @end table
  2448. @item phase
  2449. Set phase.
  2450. Possible values are:
  2451. @table @var
  2452. @item laminar
  2453. @item independent
  2454. @end table
  2455. @item window
  2456. Set processing window size.
  2457. Possible values are:
  2458. @table @var
  2459. @item standard
  2460. @item short
  2461. @item long
  2462. @end table
  2463. @item smoothing
  2464. Set smoothing.
  2465. Possible values are:
  2466. @table @var
  2467. @item off
  2468. @item on
  2469. @end table
  2470. @item formant
  2471. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  2472. Possible values are:
  2473. @table @var
  2474. @item shifted
  2475. @item preserved
  2476. @end table
  2477. @item pitchq
  2478. Set pitch quality.
  2479. Possible values are:
  2480. @table @var
  2481. @item quality
  2482. @item speed
  2483. @item consistency
  2484. @end table
  2485. @item channels
  2486. Set channels.
  2487. Possible values are:
  2488. @table @var
  2489. @item apart
  2490. @item together
  2491. @end table
  2492. @end table
  2493. @section sidechaincompress
  2494. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  2495. detected signal using second input signal.
  2496. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2497. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2498. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  2499. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  2500. The filter accepts the following options:
  2501. @table @option
  2502. @item level_in
  2503. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2504. @item threshold
  2505. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  2506. reduction of first stream.
  2507. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  2508. @item ratio
  2509. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  2510. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  2511. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  2512. @item attack
  2513. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2514. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  2515. @item release
  2516. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  2517. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  2518. @item makeup
  2519. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  2520. Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
  2521. @item knee
  2522. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2523. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  2524. @item link
  2525. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  2526. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  2527. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  2528. @item detection
  2529. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  2530. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  2531. @item level_sc
  2532. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  2533. @item mix
  2534. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  2535. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2536. @end table
  2537. @subsection Examples
  2538. @itemize
  2539. @item
  2540. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  2541. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  2542. merged with 2nd input:
  2543. @example
  2544. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  2545. @end example
  2546. @end itemize
  2547. @section sidechaingate
  2548. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  2549. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  2550. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  2551. threshold.
  2552. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  2553. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  2554. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  2555. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  2556. guitar.
  2557. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  2558. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  2559. The filter accepts the following options:
  2560. @table @option
  2561. @item level_in
  2562. Set input level before filtering.
  2563. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2564. @item range
  2565. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  2566. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2567. @item threshold
  2568. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  2569. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2570. @item ratio
  2571. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  2572. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  2573. @item attack
  2574. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  2575. reduction stops.
  2576. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2577. @item release
  2578. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  2579. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  2580. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  2581. @item makeup
  2582. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  2583. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  2584. @item knee
  2585. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  2586. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  2587. @item detection
  2588. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  2589. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  2590. @item link
  2591. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  2592. the reduction.
  2593. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  2594. @item level_sc
  2595. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2596. @end table
  2597. @section silencedetect
  2598. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  2599. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  2600. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  2601. minimum detected noise duration.
  2602. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
  2603. The filter accepts the following options:
  2604. @table @option
  2605. @item duration, d
  2606. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  2607. @item noise, n
  2608. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  2609. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  2610. @end table
  2611. @subsection Examples
  2612. @itemize
  2613. @item
  2614. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  2615. @example
  2616. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  2617. @end example
  2618. @item
  2619. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  2620. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  2621. @example
  2622. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  2623. @end example
  2624. @end itemize
  2625. @section silenceremove
  2626. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  2627. The filter accepts the following options:
  2628. @table @option
  2629. @item start_periods
  2630. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  2631. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  2632. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  2633. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  2634. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  2635. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  2636. Default value is @code{0}.
  2637. @item start_duration
  2638. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  2639. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  2640. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  2641. @item start_threshold
  2642. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  2643. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  2644. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  2645. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2646. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2647. @item stop_periods
  2648. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  2649. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  2650. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  2651. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  2652. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  2653. in the middle of the audio.
  2654. Default value is @code{0}.
  2655. @item stop_duration
  2656. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  2657. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  2658. the audio.
  2659. Default value is @code{0}.
  2660. @item stop_threshold
  2661. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  2662. the end of audio.
  2663. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  2664. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  2665. @item leave_silence
  2666. This indicate that @var{stop_duration} length of audio should be left intact
  2667. at the beginning of each period of silence.
  2668. For example, if you want to remove long pauses between words but do not want
  2669. to remove the pauses completely. Default value is @code{0}.
  2670. @item detection
  2671. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  2672. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  2673. Default value is @code{rms}.
  2674. @item window
  2675. Set ratio used to calculate size of window for detecting silence.
  2676. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  2677. @end table
  2678. @subsection Examples
  2679. @itemize
  2680. @item
  2681. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  2682. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  2683. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  2684. @example
  2685. silenceremove=1:5:0.02
  2686. @end example
  2687. @item
  2688. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  2689. second of silence in audio:
  2690. @example
  2691. silenceremove=0:0:0:-1:1:-90dB
  2692. @end example
  2693. @end itemize
  2694. @section sofalizer
  2695. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  2696. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  2697. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  2698. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  2699. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  2700. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  2701. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2702. @code{--enable-netcdf}.
  2703. The filter accepts the following options:
  2704. @table @option
  2705. @item sofa
  2706. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  2707. @item gain
  2708. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  2709. @item rotation
  2710. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2711. @item elevation
  2712. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  2713. @item radius
  2714. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  2715. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  2716. @item type
  2717. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  2718. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  2719. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  2720. Default is @var{freq}.
  2721. @item speakers
  2722. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  2723. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  2724. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  2725. azimuth and elevation in degreees.
  2726. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  2727. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  2728. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  2729. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  2730. @end table
  2731. @subsection Examples
  2732. @itemize
  2733. @item
  2734. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  2735. @example
  2736. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  2737. @end example
  2738. @item
  2739. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  2740. @example
  2741. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  2742. @end example
  2743. @item
  2744. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, rear left and rear right
  2745. and also with custom gain:
  2746. @example
  2747. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|RL 135|RR 225:gain=28"
  2748. @end example
  2749. @end itemize
  2750. @section stereotools
  2751. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  2752. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  2753. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  2754. The filter accepts the following options:
  2755. @table @option
  2756. @item level_in
  2757. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2758. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2759. @item level_out
  2760. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  2761. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2762. @item balance_in
  2763. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2764. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2765. @item balance_out
  2766. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  2767. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2768. @item softclip
  2769. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  2770. clipping. Disabled by default.
  2771. @item mutel
  2772. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2773. @item muter
  2774. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2775. @item phasel
  2776. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  2777. @item phaser
  2778. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  2779. @item mode
  2780. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  2781. @table @samp
  2782. @item lr>lr
  2783. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  2784. @item lr>ms
  2785. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  2786. @item ms>lr
  2787. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  2788. @item lr>ll
  2789. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  2790. @item lr>rr
  2791. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  2792. @item lr>l+r
  2793. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  2794. @item lr>rl
  2795. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  2796. @end table
  2797. @item slev
  2798. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  2799. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2800. @item sbal
  2801. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  2802. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2803. @item mlev
  2804. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  2805. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  2806. @item mpan
  2807. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2808. @item base
  2809. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  2810. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  2811. @item delay
  2812. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  2813. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  2814. @item sclevel
  2815. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  2816. @item phase
  2817. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  2818. @end table
  2819. @subsection Examples
  2820. @itemize
  2821. @item
  2822. Apply karaoke like effect:
  2823. @example
  2824. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  2825. @end example
  2826. @item
  2827. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  2828. @example
  2829. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  2830. @end example
  2831. @end itemize
  2832. @section stereowiden
  2833. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  2834. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  2835. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  2836. The filter accepts the following options:
  2837. @table @option
  2838. @item delay
  2839. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  2840. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  2841. @item feedback
  2842. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  2843. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  2844. effect. Default is 0.3.
  2845. @item crossfeed
  2846. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  2847. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  2848. channels. Default is 0.3.
  2849. @item drymix
  2850. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  2851. @end table
  2852. @section treble
  2853. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2854. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2855. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2856. The filter accepts the following options:
  2857. @table @option
  2858. @item gain, g
  2859. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  2860. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  2861. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2862. @item frequency, f
  2863. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2864. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2865. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  2866. @item width_type
  2867. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2868. @table @option
  2869. @item h
  2870. Hz
  2871. @item q
  2872. Q-Factor
  2873. @item o
  2874. octave
  2875. @item s
  2876. slope
  2877. @end table
  2878. @item width, w
  2879. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2880. @end table
  2881. @section tremolo
  2882. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  2883. The filter accepts the following options:
  2884. @table @option
  2885. @item f
  2886. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  2887. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  2888. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  2889. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  2890. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2891. @item d
  2892. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2893. Default value is 0.5.
  2894. @end table
  2895. @section vibrato
  2896. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  2897. The filter accepts the following options:
  2898. @table @option
  2899. @item f
  2900. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  2901. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  2902. @item d
  2903. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  2904. Default value is 0.5.
  2905. @end table
  2906. @section volume
  2907. Adjust the input audio volume.
  2908. It accepts the following parameters:
  2909. @table @option
  2910. @item volume
  2911. Set audio volume expression.
  2912. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  2913. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  2914. @example
  2915. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  2916. @end example
  2917. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  2918. @item precision
  2919. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  2920. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  2921. precision of the volume scaling.
  2922. @table @option
  2923. @item fixed
  2924. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  2925. @item float
  2926. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  2927. @item double
  2928. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  2929. @end table
  2930. @item replaygain
  2931. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  2932. @table @option
  2933. @item drop
  2934. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  2935. @item ignore
  2936. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  2937. @item track
  2938. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  2939. @item album
  2940. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  2941. @end table
  2942. @item replaygain_preamp
  2943. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  2944. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  2945. @item eval
  2946. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  2947. It accepts the following values:
  2948. @table @samp
  2949. @item once
  2950. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  2951. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  2952. @item frame
  2953. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  2954. @end table
  2955. Default value is @samp{once}.
  2956. @end table
  2957. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  2958. @table @option
  2959. @item n
  2960. frame number (starting at zero)
  2961. @item nb_channels
  2962. number of channels
  2963. @item nb_consumed_samples
  2964. number of samples consumed by the filter
  2965. @item nb_samples
  2966. number of samples in the current frame
  2967. @item pos
  2968. original frame position in the file
  2969. @item pts
  2970. frame PTS
  2971. @item sample_rate
  2972. sample rate
  2973. @item startpts
  2974. PTS at start of stream
  2975. @item startt
  2976. time at start of stream
  2977. @item t
  2978. frame time
  2979. @item tb
  2980. timestamp timebase
  2981. @item volume
  2982. last set volume value
  2983. @end table
  2984. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  2985. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  2986. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  2987. @subsection Commands
  2988. This filter supports the following commands:
  2989. @table @option
  2990. @item volume
  2991. Modify the volume expression.
  2992. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  2993. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  2994. value.
  2995. @item replaygain_noclip
  2996. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  2997. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  2998. @end table
  2999. @subsection Examples
  3000. @itemize
  3001. @item
  3002. Halve the input audio volume:
  3003. @example
  3004. volume=volume=0.5
  3005. volume=volume=1/2
  3006. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  3007. @end example
  3008. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  3009. omitted, for example like in:
  3010. @example
  3011. volume=0.5
  3012. @end example
  3013. @item
  3014. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  3015. @example
  3016. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  3017. @end example
  3018. @item
  3019. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  3020. @example
  3021. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  3022. @end example
  3023. @end itemize
  3024. @section volumedetect
  3025. Detect the volume of the input video.
  3026. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  3027. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  3028. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  3029. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  3030. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  3031. the samples).
  3032. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  3033. @subsection Examples
  3034. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  3035. @example
  3036. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  3037. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  3038. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  3039. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  3040. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  3041. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  3042. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  3043. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  3044. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  3045. @end example
  3046. It means that:
  3047. @itemize
  3048. @item
  3049. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  3050. @item
  3051. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  3052. @item
  3053. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  3054. @end itemize
  3055. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  3056. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  3057. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  3058. @chapter Audio Sources
  3059. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  3060. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  3061. @section abuffer
  3062. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  3063. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  3064. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  3065. It accepts the following parameters:
  3066. @table @option
  3067. @item time_base
  3068. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  3069. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  3070. @item sample_rate
  3071. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  3072. @item sample_fmt
  3073. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  3074. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  3075. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  3076. @item channel_layout
  3077. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  3078. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  3079. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  3080. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  3081. @item channels
  3082. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  3083. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  3084. must be consistent.
  3085. @end table
  3086. @subsection Examples
  3087. @example
  3088. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  3089. @end example
  3090. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  3091. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  3092. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  3093. equivalent to:
  3094. @example
  3095. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  3096. @end example
  3097. @section aevalsrc
  3098. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  3099. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  3100. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  3101. audio signal.
  3102. This source accepts the following options:
  3103. @table @option
  3104. @item exprs
  3105. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  3106. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  3107. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  3108. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  3109. @item channel_layout, c
  3110. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  3111. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  3112. @item duration, d
  3113. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3114. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3115. for the accepted syntax.
  3116. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  3117. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  3118. complete frame.
  3119. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3120. supposed to be generated forever.
  3121. @item nb_samples, n
  3122. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  3123. default to 1024.
  3124. @item sample_rate, s
  3125. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  3126. @end table
  3127. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  3128. @table @option
  3129. @item n
  3130. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  3131. @item t
  3132. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  3133. @item s
  3134. sample rate
  3135. @end table
  3136. @subsection Examples
  3137. @itemize
  3138. @item
  3139. Generate silence:
  3140. @example
  3141. aevalsrc=0
  3142. @end example
  3143. @item
  3144. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  3145. 8000 Hz:
  3146. @example
  3147. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  3148. @end example
  3149. @item
  3150. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  3151. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  3152. @example
  3153. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  3154. @end example
  3155. @item
  3156. Generate white noise:
  3157. @example
  3158. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  3159. @end example
  3160. @item
  3161. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  3162. @example
  3163. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  3164. @end example
  3165. @item
  3166. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  3167. @example
  3168. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  3169. @end example
  3170. @end itemize
  3171. @section anullsrc
  3172. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  3173. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  3174. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  3175. synth filter).
  3176. This source accepts the following options:
  3177. @table @option
  3178. @item channel_layout, cl
  3179. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  3180. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  3181. is "stereo".
  3182. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  3183. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  3184. channel layout values.
  3185. @item sample_rate, r
  3186. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  3187. @item nb_samples, n
  3188. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  3189. @end table
  3190. @subsection Examples
  3191. @itemize
  3192. @item
  3193. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  3194. @example
  3195. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  3196. @end example
  3197. @item
  3198. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  3199. @example
  3200. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  3201. @end example
  3202. @end itemize
  3203. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  3204. @section flite
  3205. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  3206. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3207. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  3208. Note that the flite library is not thread-safe.
  3209. The filter accepts the following options:
  3210. @table @option
  3211. @item list_voices
  3212. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  3213. immediately. Default value is 0.
  3214. @item nb_samples, n
  3215. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  3216. @item textfile
  3217. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  3218. @item text
  3219. Set the text to speak.
  3220. @item voice, v
  3221. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  3222. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  3223. @end table
  3224. @subsection Examples
  3225. @itemize
  3226. @item
  3227. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  3228. standard flite voice:
  3229. @example
  3230. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  3231. @end example
  3232. @item
  3233. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  3234. @example
  3235. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3236. @end example
  3237. @item
  3238. Input text to ffmpeg:
  3239. @example
  3240. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  3241. @end example
  3242. @item
  3243. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  3244. the @code{lavfi} device:
  3245. @example
  3246. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  3247. @end example
  3248. @end itemize
  3249. For more information about libflite, check:
  3250. @url{http://www.speech.cs.cmu.edu/flite/}
  3251. @section anoisesrc
  3252. Generate a noise audio signal.
  3253. The filter accepts the following options:
  3254. @table @option
  3255. @item sample_rate, r
  3256. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  3257. @item amplitude, a
  3258. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  3259. is 1.0.
  3260. @item duration, d
  3261. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  3262. results in noise with an infinite length.
  3263. @item color, colour, c
  3264. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, and brown.
  3265. Default color is white.
  3266. @item seed, s
  3267. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  3268. @item nb_samples, n
  3269. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  3270. @end table
  3271. @subsection Examples
  3272. @itemize
  3273. @item
  3274. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  3275. @example
  3276. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  3277. @end example
  3278. @end itemize
  3279. @section sine
  3280. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  3281. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  3282. The filter accepts the following options:
  3283. @table @option
  3284. @item frequency, f
  3285. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  3286. @item beep_factor, b
  3287. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  3288. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  3289. @item sample_rate, r
  3290. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  3291. @item duration, d
  3292. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  3293. @item samples_per_frame
  3294. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  3295. The expression can contain the following constants:
  3296. @table @option
  3297. @item n
  3298. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  3299. @item pts
  3300. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  3301. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  3302. @item t
  3303. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  3304. @item TB
  3305. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  3306. @end table
  3307. Default is @code{1024}.
  3308. @end table
  3309. @subsection Examples
  3310. @itemize
  3311. @item
  3312. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  3313. @example
  3314. sine
  3315. @end example
  3316. @item
  3317. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  3318. @example
  3319. sine=220:4:d=5
  3320. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  3321. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  3322. @end example
  3323. @item
  3324. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  3325. pattern:
  3326. @example
  3327. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  3328. @end example
  3329. @end itemize
  3330. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  3331. @chapter Audio Sinks
  3332. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  3333. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  3334. @section abuffersink
  3335. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  3336. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  3337. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  3338. or the options system.
  3339. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  3340. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  3341. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  3342. @section anullsink
  3343. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  3344. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  3345. tools.
  3346. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  3347. @chapter Video Filters
  3348. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  3349. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  3350. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  3351. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  3352. build.
  3353. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  3354. @section alphaextract
  3355. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  3356. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  3357. @section alphamerge
  3358. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  3359. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  3360. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  3361. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  3362. channel.
  3363. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  3364. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  3365. @example
  3366. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  3367. @end example
  3368. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  3369. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  3370. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  3371. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  3372. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  3373. @section ass
  3374. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  3375. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  3376. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  3377. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  3378. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  3379. @table @option
  3380. @item shaping
  3381. Set the shaping engine
  3382. Available values are:
  3383. @table @samp
  3384. @item auto
  3385. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  3386. @item simple
  3387. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  3388. @item complex
  3389. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  3390. @end table
  3391. The default is @code{auto}.
  3392. @end table
  3393. @section atadenoise
  3394. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  3395. The filter accepts the following options:
  3396. @table @option
  3397. @item 0a
  3398. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  3399. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3400. @item 0b
  3401. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  3402. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3403. @item 1a
  3404. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3405. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3406. @item 1b
  3407. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3408. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3409. @item 2a
  3410. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  3411. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  3412. @item 2b
  3413. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  3414. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  3415. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  3416. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  3417. @item s
  3418. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 33. Must be odd
  3419. number in range [5, 129].
  3420. @item p
  3421. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  3422. @end table
  3423. @section avgblur
  3424. Apply average blur filter.
  3425. The filter accepts the following options:
  3426. @table @option
  3427. @item sizeX
  3428. Set horizontal kernel size.
  3429. @item planes
  3430. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  3431. @item sizeY
  3432. Set vertical kernel size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  3433. Default is @code{0}.
  3434. @end table
  3435. @section bbox
  3436. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  3437. luminance plane.
  3438. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  3439. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  3440. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  3441. log.
  3442. The filter accepts the following option:
  3443. @table @option
  3444. @item min_val
  3445. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  3446. @end table
  3447. @section bitplanenoise
  3448. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  3449. The filter accepts the following options:
  3450. @table @option
  3451. @item bitplane
  3452. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  3453. @item filter
  3454. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  3455. Default is disabled.
  3456. @end table
  3457. @section blackdetect
  3458. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  3459. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  3460. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  3461. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  3462. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3463. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3464. The filter accepts the following options:
  3465. @table @option
  3466. @item black_min_duration, d
  3467. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  3468. be a non-negative floating point number.
  3469. Default value is 2.0.
  3470. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  3471. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  3472. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  3473. @example
  3474. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  3475. @end example
  3476. for which a picture is considered black.
  3477. Default value is 0.98.
  3478. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  3479. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  3480. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  3481. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  3482. the following equation:
  3483. @example
  3484. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  3485. @end example
  3486. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  3487. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  3488. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  3489. Default value is 0.10.
  3490. @end table
  3491. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  3492. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  3493. @example
  3494. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  3495. @end example
  3496. @section blackframe
  3497. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  3498. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  3499. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  3500. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  3501. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  3502. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  3503. It accepts the following parameters:
  3504. @table @option
  3505. @item amount
  3506. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  3507. @code{98}.
  3508. @item threshold, thresh
  3509. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  3510. @code{32}.
  3511. @end table
  3512. @section blend, tblend
  3513. Blend two video frames into each other.
  3514. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  3515. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  3516. "bottom" layer. Output terminates when shortest input terminates.
  3517. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  3518. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  3519. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  3520. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3521. @table @option
  3522. @item c0_mode
  3523. @item c1_mode
  3524. @item c2_mode
  3525. @item c3_mode
  3526. @item all_mode
  3527. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3528. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  3529. Available values for component modes are:
  3530. @table @samp
  3531. @item addition
  3532. @item addition128
  3533. @item and
  3534. @item average
  3535. @item burn
  3536. @item darken
  3537. @item difference
  3538. @item difference128
  3539. @item divide
  3540. @item dodge
  3541. @item freeze
  3542. @item exclusion
  3543. @item glow
  3544. @item hardlight
  3545. @item hardmix
  3546. @item heat
  3547. @item lighten
  3548. @item linearlight
  3549. @item multiply
  3550. @item multiply128
  3551. @item negation
  3552. @item normal
  3553. @item or
  3554. @item overlay
  3555. @item phoenix
  3556. @item pinlight
  3557. @item reflect
  3558. @item screen
  3559. @item softlight
  3560. @item subtract
  3561. @item vividlight
  3562. @item xor
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item c0_opacity
  3565. @item c1_opacity
  3566. @item c2_opacity
  3567. @item c3_opacity
  3568. @item all_opacity
  3569. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3570. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  3571. @item c0_expr
  3572. @item c1_expr
  3573. @item c2_expr
  3574. @item c3_expr
  3575. @item all_expr
  3576. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  3577. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  3578. The expressions can use the following variables:
  3579. @table @option
  3580. @item N
  3581. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  3582. @item X
  3583. @item Y
  3584. the coordinates of the current sample
  3585. @item W
  3586. @item H
  3587. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  3588. @item SW
  3589. @item SH
  3590. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  3591. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  3592. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  3593. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  3594. @item T
  3595. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  3596. @item TOP, A
  3597. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  3598. @item BOTTOM, B
  3599. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  3600. @end table
  3601. @item shortest
  3602. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is
  3603. @code{0}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3604. @item repeatlast
  3605. Continue applying the last bottom frame after the end of the stream. A value of
  3606. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the bottom layer is reached.
  3607. Default is @code{1}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
  3608. @end table
  3609. @subsection Examples
  3610. @itemize
  3611. @item
  3612. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  3613. @example
  3614. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  3615. @end example
  3616. @item
  3617. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  3618. @example
  3619. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  3620. @end example
  3621. @item
  3622. Apply uncover left effect:
  3623. @example
  3624. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  3625. @end example
  3626. @item
  3627. Apply uncover down effect:
  3628. @example
  3629. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  3630. @end example
  3631. @item
  3632. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  3633. @example
  3634. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  3635. @end example
  3636. @item
  3637. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  3638. @example
  3639. blend=all_expr=if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)
  3640. @end example
  3641. @item
  3642. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  3643. @example
  3644. tblend=all_mode=difference128
  3645. @end example
  3646. @end itemize
  3647. @section boxblur
  3648. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  3649. It accepts the following parameters:
  3650. @table @option
  3651. @item luma_radius, lr
  3652. @item luma_power, lp
  3653. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3654. @item chroma_power, cp
  3655. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3656. @item alpha_power, ap
  3657. @end table
  3658. A description of the accepted options follows.
  3659. @table @option
  3660. @item luma_radius, lr
  3661. @item chroma_radius, cr
  3662. @item alpha_radius, ar
  3663. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  3664. corresponding input plane.
  3665. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  3666. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  3667. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  3668. planes.
  3669. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  3670. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  3671. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  3672. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  3673. @table @option
  3674. @item w
  3675. @item h
  3676. The input width and height in pixels.
  3677. @item cw
  3678. @item ch
  3679. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  3680. @item hsub
  3681. @item vsub
  3682. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  3683. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  3684. @end table
  3685. @item luma_power, lp
  3686. @item chroma_power, cp
  3687. @item alpha_power, ap
  3688. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  3689. corresponding plane.
  3690. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  3691. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  3692. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  3693. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  3694. @end table
  3695. @subsection Examples
  3696. @itemize
  3697. @item
  3698. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  3699. set to 2:
  3700. @example
  3701. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  3702. boxblur=2:1
  3703. @end example
  3704. @item
  3705. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  3706. @example
  3707. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  3708. @end example
  3709. @item
  3710. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  3711. @example
  3712. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  3713. @end example
  3714. @end itemize
  3715. @section bwdif
  3716. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  3717. Deinterlacing Filter").
  3718. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  3719. interpolation algorithms.
  3720. It accepts the following parameters:
  3721. @table @option
  3722. @item mode
  3723. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  3724. @table @option
  3725. @item 0, send_frame
  3726. Output one frame for each frame.
  3727. @item 1, send_field
  3728. Output one frame for each field.
  3729. @end table
  3730. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  3731. @item parity
  3732. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  3733. of the following values:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item 0, tff
  3736. Assume the top field is first.
  3737. @item 1, bff
  3738. Assume the bottom field is first.
  3739. @item -1, auto
  3740. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  3741. @end table
  3742. The default value is @code{auto}.
  3743. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  3744. top field first will be assumed.
  3745. @item deint
  3746. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  3747. values:
  3748. @table @option
  3749. @item 0, all
  3750. Deinterlace all frames.
  3751. @item 1, interlaced
  3752. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  3753. @end table
  3754. The default value is @code{all}.
  3755. @end table
  3756. @section chromakey
  3757. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  3758. The filter accepts the following options:
  3759. @table @option
  3760. @item color
  3761. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3762. @item similarity
  3763. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3764. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3765. @item blend
  3766. Blend percentage.
  3767. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3768. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3769. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3770. @item yuv
  3771. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  3772. Litteral colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  3773. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  3774. @end table
  3775. @subsection Examples
  3776. @itemize
  3777. @item
  3778. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3779. @example
  3780. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  3781. @end example
  3782. @item
  3783. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  3784. @example
  3785. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  3786. @end example
  3787. @end itemize
  3788. @section ciescope
  3789. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  3790. The filter accepts the following options:
  3791. @table @option
  3792. @item system
  3793. Set color system.
  3794. @table @samp
  3795. @item ntsc, 470m
  3796. @item ebu, 470bg
  3797. @item smpte
  3798. @item 240m
  3799. @item apple
  3800. @item widergb
  3801. @item cie1931
  3802. @item rec709, hdtv
  3803. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  3804. @end table
  3805. @item cie
  3806. Set CIE system.
  3807. @table @samp
  3808. @item xyy
  3809. @item ucs
  3810. @item luv
  3811. @end table
  3812. @item gamuts
  3813. Set what gamuts to draw.
  3814. See @code{system} option for available values.
  3815. @item size, s
  3816. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  3817. @item intensity, i
  3818. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  3819. @item contrast
  3820. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  3821. @item corrgamma
  3822. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  3823. @item showwhite
  3824. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  3825. @item gamma
  3826. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  3827. @end table
  3828. @section codecview
  3829. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  3830. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  3831. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  3832. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  3833. The filter accepts the following option:
  3834. @table @option
  3835. @item mv
  3836. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  3837. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  3838. @table @samp
  3839. @item pf
  3840. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  3841. @item bf
  3842. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3843. @item bb
  3844. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  3845. @end table
  3846. @item qp
  3847. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  3848. @item mv_type, mvt
  3849. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  3850. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  3851. @table @samp
  3852. @item fp
  3853. forward predicted MVs
  3854. @item bp
  3855. backward predicted MVs
  3856. @end table
  3857. @item frame_type, ft
  3858. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  3859. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  3860. @table @samp
  3861. @item if
  3862. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  3863. @item pf
  3864. predicted frames (P-frames)
  3865. @item bf
  3866. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  3867. @end table
  3868. @end table
  3869. @subsection Examples
  3870. @itemize
  3871. @item
  3872. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  3873. @example
  3874. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  3875. @end example
  3876. @item
  3877. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  3878. @example
  3879. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  3880. @end example
  3881. @end itemize
  3882. @section colorbalance
  3883. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  3884. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  3885. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  3886. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  3887. value towards the complementary color.
  3888. The filter accepts the following options:
  3889. @table @option
  3890. @item rs
  3891. @item gs
  3892. @item bs
  3893. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  3894. @item rm
  3895. @item gm
  3896. @item bm
  3897. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  3898. @item rh
  3899. @item gh
  3900. @item bh
  3901. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  3902. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3903. @end table
  3904. @subsection Examples
  3905. @itemize
  3906. @item
  3907. Add red color cast to shadows:
  3908. @example
  3909. colorbalance=rs=.3
  3910. @end example
  3911. @end itemize
  3912. @section colorkey
  3913. RGB colorspace color keying.
  3914. The filter accepts the following options:
  3915. @table @option
  3916. @item color
  3917. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  3918. @item similarity
  3919. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  3920. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  3921. @item blend
  3922. Blend percentage.
  3923. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  3924. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  3925. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  3926. @end table
  3927. @subsection Examples
  3928. @itemize
  3929. @item
  3930. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  3931. @example
  3932. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  3933. @end example
  3934. @item
  3935. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  3936. @example
  3937. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  3938. @end example
  3939. @end itemize
  3940. @section colorlevels
  3941. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  3942. The filter accepts the following options:
  3943. @table @option
  3944. @item rimin
  3945. @item gimin
  3946. @item bimin
  3947. @item aimin
  3948. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  3949. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3950. @item rimax
  3951. @item gimax
  3952. @item bimax
  3953. @item aimax
  3954. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  3955. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3956. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  3957. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  3958. @item romin
  3959. @item gomin
  3960. @item bomin
  3961. @item aomin
  3962. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  3963. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  3964. @item romax
  3965. @item gomax
  3966. @item bomax
  3967. @item aomax
  3968. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  3969. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  3970. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  3971. @end table
  3972. @subsection Examples
  3973. @itemize
  3974. @item
  3975. Make video output darker:
  3976. @example
  3977. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  3978. @end example
  3979. @item
  3980. Increase contrast:
  3981. @example
  3982. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  3983. @end example
  3984. @item
  3985. Make video output lighter:
  3986. @example
  3987. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  3988. @end example
  3989. @item
  3990. Increase brightness:
  3991. @example
  3992. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  3993. @end example
  3994. @end itemize
  3995. @section colorchannelmixer
  3996. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  3997. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  3998. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  3999. modify is red, the output value will be:
  4000. @example
  4001. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  4002. @end example
  4003. The filter accepts the following options:
  4004. @table @option
  4005. @item rr
  4006. @item rg
  4007. @item rb
  4008. @item ra
  4009. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  4010. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  4011. @item gr
  4012. @item gg
  4013. @item gb
  4014. @item ga
  4015. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  4016. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  4017. @item br
  4018. @item bg
  4019. @item bb
  4020. @item ba
  4021. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  4022. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  4023. @item ar
  4024. @item ag
  4025. @item ab
  4026. @item aa
  4027. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  4028. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  4029. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  4030. @end table
  4031. @subsection Examples
  4032. @itemize
  4033. @item
  4034. Convert source to grayscale:
  4035. @example
  4036. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  4037. @end example
  4038. @item
  4039. Simulate sepia tones:
  4040. @example
  4041. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  4042. @end example
  4043. @end itemize
  4044. @section colormatrix
  4045. Convert color matrix.
  4046. The filter accepts the following options:
  4047. @table @option
  4048. @item src
  4049. @item dst
  4050. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  4051. specified.
  4052. The accepted values are:
  4053. @table @samp
  4054. @item bt709
  4055. BT.709
  4056. @item bt601
  4057. BT.601
  4058. @item smpte240m
  4059. SMPTE-240M
  4060. @item fcc
  4061. FCC
  4062. @item bt2020
  4063. BT.2020
  4064. @end table
  4065. @end table
  4066. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  4067. @example
  4068. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  4069. @end example
  4070. @section colorspace
  4071. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  4072. The filter accepts the following options:
  4073. @table @option
  4074. @anchor{all}
  4075. @item all
  4076. Specify all color properties at once.
  4077. The accepted values are:
  4078. @table @samp
  4079. @item bt470m
  4080. BT.470M
  4081. @item bt470bg
  4082. BT.470BG
  4083. @item bt601-6-525
  4084. BT.601-6 525
  4085. @item bt601-6-625
  4086. BT.601-6 625
  4087. @item bt709
  4088. BT.709
  4089. @item smpte170m
  4090. SMPTE-170M
  4091. @item smpte240m
  4092. SMPTE-240M
  4093. @item bt2020
  4094. BT.2020
  4095. @end table
  4096. @anchor{space}
  4097. @item space
  4098. Specify output colorspace.
  4099. The accepted values are:
  4100. @table @samp
  4101. @item bt709
  4102. BT.709
  4103. @item fcc
  4104. FCC
  4105. @item bt470bg
  4106. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  4107. @item smpte170m
  4108. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  4109. @item smpte240m
  4110. SMPTE-240M
  4111. @item bt2020ncl
  4112. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  4113. @end table
  4114. @anchor{trc}
  4115. @item trc
  4116. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  4117. The accepted values are:
  4118. @table @samp
  4119. @item bt709
  4120. BT.709
  4121. @item gamma22
  4122. Constant gamma of 2.2
  4123. @item gamma28
  4124. Constant gamma of 2.8
  4125. @item smpte170m
  4126. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  4127. @item smpte240m
  4128. SMPTE-240M
  4129. @item bt2020-10
  4130. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  4131. @item bt2020-12
  4132. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  4133. @end table
  4134. @anchor{primaries}
  4135. @item primaries
  4136. Specify output color primaries.
  4137. The accepted values are:
  4138. @table @samp
  4139. @item bt709
  4140. BT.709
  4141. @item bt470m
  4142. BT.470M
  4143. @item bt470bg
  4144. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  4145. @item smpte170m
  4146. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  4147. @item smpte240m
  4148. SMPTE-240M
  4149. @item bt2020
  4150. BT.2020
  4151. @end table
  4152. @anchor{range}
  4153. @item range
  4154. Specify output color range.
  4155. The accepted values are:
  4156. @table @samp
  4157. @item mpeg
  4158. MPEG (restricted) range
  4159. @item jpeg
  4160. JPEG (full) range
  4161. @end table
  4162. @item format
  4163. Specify output color format.
  4164. The accepted values are:
  4165. @table @samp
  4166. @item yuv420p
  4167. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  4168. @item yuv420p10
  4169. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  4170. @item yuv420p12
  4171. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  4172. @item yuv422p
  4173. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  4174. @item yuv422p10
  4175. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  4176. @item yuv422p12
  4177. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  4178. @item yuv444p
  4179. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  4180. @item yuv444p10
  4181. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  4182. @item yuv444p12
  4183. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  4184. @end table
  4185. @item fast
  4186. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  4187. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  4188. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  4189. @item dither
  4190. Specify dithering mode.
  4191. The accepted values are:
  4192. @table @samp
  4193. @item none
  4194. No dithering
  4195. @item fsb
  4196. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  4197. @end table
  4198. @item wpadapt
  4199. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  4200. The accepted values are:
  4201. @table @samp
  4202. @item bradford
  4203. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  4204. @item vonkries
  4205. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  4206. @item identity
  4207. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  4208. @end table
  4209. @item iall
  4210. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  4211. @item ispace
  4212. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  4213. @item iprimaries
  4214. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  4215. @item itrc
  4216. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  4217. @item irange
  4218. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  4219. @end table
  4220. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  4221. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  4222. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  4223. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  4224. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  4225. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  4226. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  4227. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  4228. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  4229. @example
  4230. colorspace=smpte240m
  4231. @end example
  4232. @section convolution
  4233. Apply convolution 3x3 or 5x5 filter.
  4234. The filter accepts the following options:
  4235. @table @option
  4236. @item 0m
  4237. @item 1m
  4238. @item 2m
  4239. @item 3m
  4240. Set matrix for each plane.
  4241. Matrix is sequence of 9 or 25 signed integers.
  4242. @item 0rdiv
  4243. @item 1rdiv
  4244. @item 2rdiv
  4245. @item 3rdiv
  4246. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  4247. @item 0bias
  4248. @item 1bias
  4249. @item 2bias
  4250. @item 3bias
  4251. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  4252. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  4253. @end table
  4254. @subsection Examples
  4255. @itemize
  4256. @item
  4257. Apply sharpen:
  4258. @example
  4259. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  4260. @end example
  4261. @item
  4262. Apply blur:
  4263. @example
  4264. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  4265. @end example
  4266. @item
  4267. Apply edge enhance:
  4268. @example
  4269. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  4270. @end example
  4271. @item
  4272. Apply edge detect:
  4273. @example
  4274. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  4275. @end example
  4276. @item
  4277. Apply emboss:
  4278. @example
  4279. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  4280. @end example
  4281. @end itemize
  4282. @section copy
  4283. Copy the input source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  4284. testing purposes.
  4285. @anchor{coreimage}
  4286. @section coreimage
  4287. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  4288. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  4289. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  4290. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  4291. the respective OSX.
  4292. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  4293. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  4294. with its options.
  4295. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  4296. @table @option
  4297. @item list_filters
  4298. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  4299. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  4300. values.
  4301. @example
  4302. list_filters=true
  4303. @end example
  4304. @item filter
  4305. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  4306. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  4307. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  4308. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  4309. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  4310. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  4311. filter.
  4312. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  4313. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  4314. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  4315. @example
  4316. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  4317. @end example
  4318. @item output_rect
  4319. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  4320. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  4321. @example
  4322. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  4323. @end example
  4324. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  4325. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  4326. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  4327. @example
  4328. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  4329. @end example
  4330. @end table
  4331. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  4332. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  4333. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  4334. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  4335. usable as intended.
  4336. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  4337. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  4338. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  4339. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  4340. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  4341. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  4342. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  4343. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  4344. output image.
  4345. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  4346. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  4347. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  4348. @subsection Examples
  4349. @itemize
  4350. @item
  4351. List all filters available:
  4352. @example
  4353. coreimage=list_filters=true
  4354. @end example
  4355. @item
  4356. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  4357. @example
  4358. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  4359. @end example
  4360. @item
  4361. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  4362. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  4363. @example
  4364. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  4365. @end example
  4366. @item
  4367. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  4368. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  4369. @example
  4370. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  4371. @end example
  4372. @end itemize
  4373. @section crop
  4374. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  4375. It accepts the following parameters:
  4376. @table @option
  4377. @item w, out_w
  4378. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  4379. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  4380. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  4381. @item h, out_h
  4382. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  4383. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  4384. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  4385. @item x
  4386. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  4387. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  4388. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  4389. @item y
  4390. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  4391. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  4392. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  4393. @item keep_aspect
  4394. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  4395. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  4396. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  4397. @item exact
  4398. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  4399. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  4400. It defaults to 0.
  4401. @end table
  4402. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  4403. expressions containing the following constants:
  4404. @table @option
  4405. @item x
  4406. @item y
  4407. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  4408. each new frame.
  4409. @item in_w
  4410. @item in_h
  4411. The input width and height.
  4412. @item iw
  4413. @item ih
  4414. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  4415. @item out_w
  4416. @item out_h
  4417. The output (cropped) width and height.
  4418. @item ow
  4419. @item oh
  4420. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  4421. @item a
  4422. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  4423. @item sar
  4424. input sample aspect ratio
  4425. @item dar
  4426. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  4427. @item hsub
  4428. @item vsub
  4429. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  4430. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  4431. @item n
  4432. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  4433. @item pos
  4434. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  4435. @item t
  4436. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  4437. @end table
  4438. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  4439. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  4440. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  4441. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  4442. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  4443. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  4444. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  4445. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  4446. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  4447. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  4448. @subsection Examples
  4449. @itemize
  4450. @item
  4451. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  4452. @example
  4453. crop=100:100:12:34
  4454. @end example
  4455. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  4456. @example
  4457. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  4458. @end example
  4459. @item
  4460. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  4461. @example
  4462. crop=100:100
  4463. @end example
  4464. @item
  4465. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  4466. @example
  4467. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  4468. @end example
  4469. @item
  4470. Crop the input video central square:
  4471. @example
  4472. crop=out_w=in_h
  4473. crop=in_h
  4474. @end example
  4475. @item
  4476. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  4477. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  4478. corner of the input image.
  4479. @example
  4480. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  4481. @end example
  4482. @item
  4483. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  4484. the top and bottom borders
  4485. @example
  4486. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  4487. @end example
  4488. @item
  4489. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  4490. @example
  4491. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  4492. @end example
  4493. @item
  4494. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  4495. @example
  4496. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  4497. @end example
  4498. @item
  4499. Apply trembling effect:
  4500. @example
  4501. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  4502. @end example
  4503. @item
  4504. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  4505. @example
  4506. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  4507. @end example
  4508. @item
  4509. Set x depending on the value of y:
  4510. @example
  4511. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  4512. @end example
  4513. @end itemize
  4514. @subsection Commands
  4515. This filter supports the following commands:
  4516. @table @option
  4517. @item w, out_w
  4518. @item h, out_h
  4519. @item x
  4520. @item y
  4521. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  4522. in the input video.
  4523. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4524. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4525. value.
  4526. @end table
  4527. @section cropdetect
  4528. Auto-detect the crop size.
  4529. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  4530. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  4531. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  4532. It accepts the following parameters:
  4533. @table @option
  4534. @item limit
  4535. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  4536. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  4537. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  4538. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  4539. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  4540. @item round
  4541. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  4542. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  4543. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  4544. encoding to most video codecs.
  4545. @item reset_count, reset
  4546. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  4547. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  4548. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  4549. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  4550. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  4551. playback.
  4552. @end table
  4553. @anchor{curves}
  4554. @section curves
  4555. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  4556. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  4557. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  4558. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  4559. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  4560. the output frame.
  4561. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  4562. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  4563. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  4564. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  4565. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  4566. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  4567. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  4568. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  4569. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  4570. The filter accepts the following options:
  4571. @table @option
  4572. @item preset
  4573. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  4574. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  4575. options takes priority on the preset values.
  4576. Available presets are:
  4577. @table @samp
  4578. @item none
  4579. @item color_negative
  4580. @item cross_process
  4581. @item darker
  4582. @item increase_contrast
  4583. @item lighter
  4584. @item linear_contrast
  4585. @item medium_contrast
  4586. @item negative
  4587. @item strong_contrast
  4588. @item vintage
  4589. @end table
  4590. Default is @code{none}.
  4591. @item master, m
  4592. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  4593. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  4594. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  4595. post-processing LUT.
  4596. @item red, r
  4597. Set the key points for the red component.
  4598. @item green, g
  4599. Set the key points for the green component.
  4600. @item blue, b
  4601. Set the key points for the blue component.
  4602. @item all
  4603. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  4604. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  4605. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  4606. @option{all} setting.
  4607. @item psfile
  4608. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  4609. @item plot
  4610. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  4611. @end table
  4612. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  4613. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  4614. @subsection Examples
  4615. @itemize
  4616. @item
  4617. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  4618. @example
  4619. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  4620. @end example
  4621. @item
  4622. Vintage effect:
  4623. @example
  4624. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  4625. @end example
  4626. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  4627. @table @var
  4628. @item red
  4629. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  4630. @item green
  4631. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  4632. @item blue
  4633. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  4634. @end table
  4635. @item
  4636. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  4637. @example
  4638. curves=preset=vintage
  4639. @end example
  4640. @item
  4641. Or simply:
  4642. @example
  4643. curves=vintage
  4644. @end example
  4645. @item
  4646. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  4647. @example
  4648. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  4649. @end example
  4650. @item
  4651. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  4652. and @command{gnuplot}:
  4653. @example
  4654. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  4655. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  4656. @end example
  4657. @end itemize
  4658. @section datascope
  4659. Video data analysis filter.
  4660. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  4661. The filter accepts the following options:
  4662. @table @option
  4663. @item size, s
  4664. Set output video size.
  4665. @item x
  4666. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  4667. @item y
  4668. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  4669. @item mode
  4670. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  4671. @table @samp
  4672. @item mono
  4673. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  4674. @item color
  4675. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  4676. background.
  4677. @item color2
  4678. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  4679. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  4680. @end table
  4681. @item axis
  4682. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  4683. @end table
  4684. @section dctdnoiz
  4685. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  4686. This filter is not designed for real time.
  4687. The filter accepts the following options:
  4688. @table @option
  4689. @item sigma, s
  4690. Set the noise sigma constant.
  4691. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  4692. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  4693. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  4694. Default is @code{0}.
  4695. @item overlap
  4696. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  4697. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  4698. risk of various artefacts.
  4699. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  4700. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  4701. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  4702. @item expr, e
  4703. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  4704. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  4705. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  4706. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  4707. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  4708. variable.
  4709. @item n
  4710. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  4711. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  4712. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  4713. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  4714. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  4715. better de-noising.
  4716. @end table
  4717. @subsection Examples
  4718. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  4719. @example
  4720. dctdnoiz=4.5
  4721. @end example
  4722. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  4723. @example
  4724. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  4725. @end example
  4726. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  4727. @example
  4728. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  4729. @end example
  4730. @section deband
  4731. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  4732. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  4733. The filter accepts the following options:
  4734. @table @option
  4735. @item 1thr
  4736. @item 2thr
  4737. @item 3thr
  4738. @item 4thr
  4739. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  4740. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  4741. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  4742. it will be considered as banded.
  4743. @item range, r
  4744. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  4745. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  4746. will be used.
  4747. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  4748. @item direction, d
  4749. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  4750. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  4751. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  4752. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  4753. column.
  4754. @item blur
  4755. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  4756. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  4757. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  4758. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  4759. @end table
  4760. @anchor{decimate}
  4761. @section decimate
  4762. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  4763. The filter accepts the following options:
  4764. @table @option
  4765. @item cycle
  4766. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  4767. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  4768. Default is @code{5}.
  4769. @item dupthresh
  4770. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  4771. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  4772. is @code{1.1}
  4773. @item scthresh
  4774. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  4775. @item blockx
  4776. @item blocky
  4777. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  4778. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  4779. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  4780. @item ppsrc
  4781. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  4782. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  4783. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  4784. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  4785. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  4786. @code{0}.
  4787. @item chroma
  4788. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  4789. @code{1}.
  4790. @end table
  4791. @section deflate
  4792. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  4793. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  4794. only values lower than the pixel.
  4795. It accepts the following options:
  4796. @table @option
  4797. @item threshold0
  4798. @item threshold1
  4799. @item threshold2
  4800. @item threshold3
  4801. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4802. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4803. @end table
  4804. @section dejudder
  4805. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  4806. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  4807. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  4808. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  4809. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  4810. rate video.
  4811. The option available in this filter is:
  4812. @table @option
  4813. @item cycle
  4814. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  4815. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  4816. @table @samp
  4817. @item 4
  4818. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  4819. @item 5
  4820. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  4821. @item 20
  4822. If a mixture of the two.
  4823. @end table
  4824. The default is @samp{4}.
  4825. @end table
  4826. @section delogo
  4827. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  4828. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  4829. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  4830. It accepts the following parameters:
  4831. @table @option
  4832. @item x
  4833. @item y
  4834. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  4835. specified.
  4836. @item w
  4837. @item h
  4838. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  4839. specified.
  4840. @item band, t
  4841. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  4842. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  4843. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  4844. is not recommended.
  4845. @item show
  4846. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  4847. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  4848. The default value is 0.
  4849. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  4850. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  4851. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  4852. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  4853. @end table
  4854. @subsection Examples
  4855. @itemize
  4856. @item
  4857. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  4858. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  4859. @example
  4860. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  4861. @end example
  4862. @end itemize
  4863. @section deshake
  4864. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  4865. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  4866. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  4867. The filter accepts the following options:
  4868. @table @option
  4869. @item x
  4870. @item y
  4871. @item w
  4872. @item h
  4873. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  4874. vectors.
  4875. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  4876. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  4877. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  4878. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  4879. box.
  4880. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  4881. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  4882. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  4883. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  4884. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  4885. Default - search the whole frame.
  4886. @item rx
  4887. @item ry
  4888. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  4889. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  4890. @item edge
  4891. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  4892. frame. Available values are:
  4893. @table @samp
  4894. @item blank, 0
  4895. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  4896. @item original, 1
  4897. Original image at blank locations
  4898. @item clamp, 2
  4899. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  4900. @item mirror, 3
  4901. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  4902. @end table
  4903. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  4904. @item blocksize
  4905. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  4906. default 8.
  4907. @item contrast
  4908. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  4909. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  4910. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  4911. @item search
  4912. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  4913. @table @samp
  4914. @item exhaustive, 0
  4915. Set exhaustive search
  4916. @item less, 1
  4917. Set less exhaustive search.
  4918. @end table
  4919. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  4920. @item filename
  4921. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  4922. specified file.
  4923. @item opencl
  4924. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  4925. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  4926. @end table
  4927. @section detelecine
  4928. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  4929. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  4930. to the telecine filter.
  4931. This filter accepts the following options:
  4932. @table @option
  4933. @item first_field
  4934. @table @samp
  4935. @item top, t
  4936. top field first
  4937. @item bottom, b
  4938. bottom field first
  4939. The default value is @code{top}.
  4940. @end table
  4941. @item pattern
  4942. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  4943. The default value is @code{23}.
  4944. @item start_frame
  4945. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  4946. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  4947. @end table
  4948. @section dilation
  4949. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  4950. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  4951. It accepts the following options:
  4952. @table @option
  4953. @item threshold0
  4954. @item threshold1
  4955. @item threshold2
  4956. @item threshold3
  4957. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  4958. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  4959. @item coordinates
  4960. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  4961. pixels are used.
  4962. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  4963. 1 2 3
  4964. 4 5
  4965. 6 7 8
  4966. @end table
  4967. @section displace
  4968. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  4969. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  4970. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  4971. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  4972. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  4973. along the y-axis.
  4974. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  4975. displacement map will be used.
  4976. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  4977. A description of the accepted options follows.
  4978. @table @option
  4979. @item edge
  4980. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  4981. Available values are:
  4982. @table @samp
  4983. @item blank
  4984. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  4985. @item smear
  4986. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  4987. @item wrap
  4988. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  4989. @end table
  4990. Default is @samp{smear}.
  4991. @end table
  4992. @subsection Examples
  4993. @itemize
  4994. @item
  4995. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  4996. @example
  4997. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  4998. @end example
  4999. @item
  5000. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  5001. @example
  5002. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  5003. @end example
  5004. @end itemize
  5005. @section drawbox
  5006. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  5007. It accepts the following parameters:
  5008. @table @option
  5009. @item x
  5010. @item y
  5011. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  5012. @item width, w
  5013. @item height, h
  5014. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  5015. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  5016. @item color, c
  5017. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  5018. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  5019. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  5020. video with inverted luma.
  5021. @item thickness, t
  5022. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge. Default value is @code{3}.
  5023. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  5024. @end table
  5025. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  5026. following constants:
  5027. @table @option
  5028. @item dar
  5029. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  5030. @item hsub
  5031. @item vsub
  5032. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5033. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5034. @item in_h, ih
  5035. @item in_w, iw
  5036. The input width and height.
  5037. @item sar
  5038. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5039. @item x
  5040. @item y
  5041. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  5042. @item w
  5043. @item h
  5044. The width and height of the drawn box.
  5045. @item t
  5046. The thickness of the drawn box.
  5047. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  5048. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  5049. @end table
  5050. @subsection Examples
  5051. @itemize
  5052. @item
  5053. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  5054. @example
  5055. drawbox
  5056. @end example
  5057. @item
  5058. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  5059. @example
  5060. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  5061. @end example
  5062. The previous example can be specified as:
  5063. @example
  5064. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  5065. @end example
  5066. @item
  5067. Fill the box with pink color:
  5068. @example
  5069. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=max
  5070. @end example
  5071. @item
  5072. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  5073. @example
  5074. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  5075. @end example
  5076. @end itemize
  5077. @section drawgrid
  5078. Draw a grid on the input image.
  5079. It accepts the following parameters:
  5080. @table @option
  5081. @item x
  5082. @item y
  5083. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  5084. @item width, w
  5085. @item height, h
  5086. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  5087. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  5088. framed. Default to 0.
  5089. @item color, c
  5090. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  5091. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
  5092. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  5093. video with inverted luma.
  5094. @item thickness, t
  5095. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  5096. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  5097. @end table
  5098. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  5099. following constants:
  5100. @table @option
  5101. @item dar
  5102. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  5103. @item hsub
  5104. @item vsub
  5105. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5106. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5107. @item in_h, ih
  5108. @item in_w, iw
  5109. The input grid cell width and height.
  5110. @item sar
  5111. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5112. @item x
  5113. @item y
  5114. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  5115. @item w
  5116. @item h
  5117. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  5118. @item t
  5119. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  5120. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  5121. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  5122. @end table
  5123. @subsection Examples
  5124. @itemize
  5125. @item
  5126. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  5127. @example
  5128. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  5129. @end example
  5130. @item
  5131. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  5132. @example
  5133. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  5134. @end example
  5135. @end itemize
  5136. @anchor{drawtext}
  5137. @section drawtext
  5138. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  5139. libfreetype library.
  5140. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  5141. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  5142. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  5143. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  5144. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  5145. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  5146. @subsection Syntax
  5147. It accepts the following parameters:
  5148. @table @option
  5149. @item box
  5150. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  5151. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  5152. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  5153. @item boxborderw
  5154. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  5155. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  5156. @item boxcolor
  5157. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  5158. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5159. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  5160. @item borderw
  5161. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  5162. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  5163. @item bordercolor
  5164. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  5165. option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5166. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  5167. @item expansion
  5168. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  5169. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  5170. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  5171. below for details.
  5172. @item fix_bounds
  5173. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  5174. @item fontcolor
  5175. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  5176. the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5177. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  5178. @item fontcolor_expr
  5179. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  5180. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  5181. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  5182. @item font
  5183. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  5184. @item fontfile
  5185. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  5186. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  5187. @item draw
  5188. This option does not exist, please see the timeline system
  5189. @item alpha
  5190. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  5191. be either a number between 0.0 and 1.0
  5192. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} do.
  5193. The default value is 1.
  5194. Please see fontcolor_expr
  5195. @item fontsize
  5196. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  5197. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  5198. @item text_shaping
  5199. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  5200. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  5201. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  5202. By default 1 (if supported).
  5203. @item ft_load_flags
  5204. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  5205. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  5206. a combination of the following values:
  5207. @table @var
  5208. @item default
  5209. @item no_scale
  5210. @item no_hinting
  5211. @item render
  5212. @item no_bitmap
  5213. @item vertical_layout
  5214. @item force_autohint
  5215. @item crop_bitmap
  5216. @item pedantic
  5217. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  5218. @item no_recurse
  5219. @item ignore_transform
  5220. @item monochrome
  5221. @item linear_design
  5222. @item no_autohint
  5223. @end table
  5224. Default value is "default".
  5225. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  5226. libfreetype flags.
  5227. @item shadowcolor
  5228. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  5229. syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  5230. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  5231. @item shadowx
  5232. @item shadowy
  5233. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  5234. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  5235. values. The default value for both is "0".
  5236. @item start_number
  5237. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  5238. is "0".
  5239. @item tabsize
  5240. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  5241. Default value is 4.
  5242. @item timecode
  5243. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  5244. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  5245. option must be specified.
  5246. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  5247. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only).
  5248. @item text
  5249. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  5250. encoded characters.
  5251. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  5252. @var{textfile}.
  5253. @item textfile
  5254. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  5255. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  5256. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  5257. parameter @var{text}.
  5258. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  5259. @item reload
  5260. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  5261. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  5262. @item x
  5263. @item y
  5264. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  5265. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  5266. output image.
  5267. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  5268. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  5269. @end table
  5270. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  5271. following constants and functions:
  5272. @table @option
  5273. @item dar
  5274. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  5275. @item hsub
  5276. @item vsub
  5277. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  5278. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5279. @item line_h, lh
  5280. the height of each text line
  5281. @item main_h, h, H
  5282. the input height
  5283. @item main_w, w, W
  5284. the input width
  5285. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  5286. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  5287. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  5288. glyphs.
  5289. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  5290. upwards.
  5291. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  5292. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  5293. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  5294. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  5295. upwards.
  5296. @item max_glyph_h
  5297. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  5298. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  5299. @var{descent}.
  5300. @item max_glyph_w
  5301. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  5302. contained in the rendered text
  5303. @item n
  5304. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  5305. @item rand(min, max)
  5306. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  5307. @item sar
  5308. The input sample aspect ratio.
  5309. @item t
  5310. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  5311. @item text_h, th
  5312. the height of the rendered text
  5313. @item text_w, tw
  5314. the width of the rendered text
  5315. @item x
  5316. @item y
  5317. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  5318. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  5319. each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  5320. @end table
  5321. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  5322. @subsection Text expansion
  5323. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  5324. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  5325. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  5326. feature is deprecated.
  5327. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  5328. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  5329. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  5330. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  5331. the second character.
  5332. Sequence of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  5333. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  5334. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  5335. they should be escaped.
  5336. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  5337. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  5338. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  5339. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  5340. problems.
  5341. The following functions are available:
  5342. @table @command
  5343. @item expr, e
  5344. The expression evaluation result.
  5345. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  5346. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  5347. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  5348. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  5349. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  5350. value.
  5351. @item expr_int_format, eif
  5352. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  5353. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  5354. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  5355. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  5356. @code{printf} function.
  5357. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  5358. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  5359. @item gmtime
  5360. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  5361. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  5362. @item localtime
  5363. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  5364. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  5365. @item metadata
  5366. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  5367. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  5368. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  5369. metadata key is not found or empty.
  5370. @item n, frame_num
  5371. The frame number, starting from 0.
  5372. @item pict_type
  5373. A 1 character description of the current picture type.
  5374. @item pts
  5375. The timestamp of the current frame.
  5376. It can take up to three arguments.
  5377. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  5378. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  5379. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  5380. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  5381. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  5382. local time zone time.
  5383. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  5384. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  5385. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  5386. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  5387. @end table
  5388. @subsection Examples
  5389. @itemize
  5390. @item
  5391. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  5392. optional parameters.
  5393. @example
  5394. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  5395. @end example
  5396. @item
  5397. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  5398. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  5399. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  5400. opacity of 20%.
  5401. @example
  5402. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  5403. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  5404. @end example
  5405. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  5406. within the parameter list.
  5407. @item
  5408. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  5409. @example
  5410. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  5411. @end example
  5412. @item
  5413. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  5414. @example
  5415. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  5416. @end example
  5417. @item
  5418. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  5419. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  5420. with no newlines.
  5421. @example
  5422. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  5423. @end example
  5424. @item
  5425. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  5426. @example
  5427. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  5428. @end example
  5429. @item
  5430. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  5431. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  5432. @example
  5433. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  5434. @end example
  5435. @item
  5436. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  5437. @example
  5438. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  5439. @end example
  5440. @item
  5441. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  5442. @example
  5443. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  5444. @end example
  5445. @item
  5446. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  5447. @example
  5448. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  5449. @end example
  5450. @item
  5451. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  5452. @example
  5453. #!/bin/sh
  5454. DS=1.0 # display start
  5455. DE=10.0 # display end
  5456. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  5457. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  5458. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  5459. @end example
  5460. @end itemize
  5461. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  5462. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  5463. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  5464. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  5465. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  5466. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  5467. @section edgedetect
  5468. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  5469. The filter accepts the following options:
  5470. @table @option
  5471. @item low
  5472. @item high
  5473. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  5474. algorithm.
  5475. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  5476. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  5477. by the low threshold.
  5478. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  5479. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  5480. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  5481. is @code{50/255}.
  5482. @item mode
  5483. Define the drawing mode.
  5484. @table @samp
  5485. @item wires
  5486. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  5487. @item colormix
  5488. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  5489. @end table
  5490. Default value is @var{wires}.
  5491. @end table
  5492. @subsection Examples
  5493. @itemize
  5494. @item
  5495. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  5496. @example
  5497. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  5498. @end example
  5499. @item
  5500. Painting effect without thresholding:
  5501. @example
  5502. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  5503. @end example
  5504. @end itemize
  5505. @section eq
  5506. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  5507. The filter accepts the following options:
  5508. @table @option
  5509. @item contrast
  5510. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  5511. @code{-2.0} to @code{2.0}. The default value is "1".
  5512. @item brightness
  5513. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  5514. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  5515. @item saturation
  5516. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  5517. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  5518. @item gamma
  5519. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  5520. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5521. @item gamma_r
  5522. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  5523. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5524. @item gamma_g
  5525. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  5526. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5527. @item gamma_b
  5528. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  5529. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  5530. @item gamma_weight
  5531. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  5532. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  5533. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  5534. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  5535. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  5536. full strength. Default is "1".
  5537. @item eval
  5538. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  5539. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  5540. It accepts the following values:
  5541. @table @samp
  5542. @item init
  5543. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  5544. when a command is processed
  5545. @item frame
  5546. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  5547. @end table
  5548. Default value is @samp{init}.
  5549. @end table
  5550. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  5551. @table @option
  5552. @item n
  5553. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  5554. @item pos
  5555. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  5556. unspecified
  5557. @item r
  5558. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  5559. @item t
  5560. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  5561. @end table
  5562. @subsection Commands
  5563. The filter supports the following commands:
  5564. @table @option
  5565. @item contrast
  5566. Set the contrast expression.
  5567. @item brightness
  5568. Set the brightness expression.
  5569. @item saturation
  5570. Set the saturation expression.
  5571. @item gamma
  5572. Set the gamma expression.
  5573. @item gamma_r
  5574. Set the gamma_r expression.
  5575. @item gamma_g
  5576. Set gamma_g expression.
  5577. @item gamma_b
  5578. Set gamma_b expression.
  5579. @item gamma_weight
  5580. Set gamma_weight expression.
  5581. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5582. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5583. value.
  5584. @end table
  5585. @section erosion
  5586. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  5587. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  5588. It accepts the following options:
  5589. @table @option
  5590. @item threshold0
  5591. @item threshold1
  5592. @item threshold2
  5593. @item threshold3
  5594. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  5595. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  5596. @item coordinates
  5597. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  5598. pixels are used.
  5599. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  5600. 1 2 3
  5601. 4 5
  5602. 6 7 8
  5603. @end table
  5604. @section extractplanes
  5605. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  5606. separate grayscale video streams.
  5607. The filter accepts the following option:
  5608. @table @option
  5609. @item planes
  5610. Set plane(s) to extract.
  5611. Available values for planes are:
  5612. @table @samp
  5613. @item y
  5614. @item u
  5615. @item v
  5616. @item a
  5617. @item r
  5618. @item g
  5619. @item b
  5620. @end table
  5621. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  5622. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  5623. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  5624. @end table
  5625. @subsection Examples
  5626. @itemize
  5627. @item
  5628. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  5629. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  5630. @example
  5631. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  5632. @end example
  5633. @end itemize
  5634. @section elbg
  5635. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  5636. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  5637. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  5638. of distinct output colors.
  5639. This filter accepts the following options.
  5640. @table @option
  5641. @item codebook_length, l
  5642. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  5643. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  5644. @item nb_steps, n
  5645. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  5646. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  5647. computation time. Default value is 1.
  5648. @item seed, s
  5649. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  5650. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  5651. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  5652. @item pal8
  5653. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  5654. length greater than 256.
  5655. @end table
  5656. @section fade
  5657. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  5658. It accepts the following parameters:
  5659. @table @option
  5660. @item type, t
  5661. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  5662. effect.
  5663. Default is @code{in}.
  5664. @item start_frame, s
  5665. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  5666. effect at. Default is 0.
  5667. @item nb_frames, n
  5668. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  5669. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  5670. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  5671. selected @option{color}.
  5672. Default is 25.
  5673. @item alpha
  5674. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  5675. Default value is 0.
  5676. @item start_time, st
  5677. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  5678. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  5679. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  5680. @item duration, d
  5681. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  5682. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  5683. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  5684. selected @option{color}.
  5685. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  5686. (nb_frames is used by default).
  5687. @item color, c
  5688. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  5689. @end table
  5690. @subsection Examples
  5691. @itemize
  5692. @item
  5693. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  5694. @example
  5695. fade=in:0:30
  5696. @end example
  5697. The command above is equivalent to:
  5698. @example
  5699. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  5700. @end example
  5701. @item
  5702. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  5703. @example
  5704. fade=out:155:45
  5705. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  5706. @end example
  5707. @item
  5708. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  5709. @example
  5710. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  5711. @end example
  5712. @item
  5713. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  5714. @example
  5715. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  5716. @end example
  5717. @item
  5718. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  5719. @example
  5720. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  5721. @end example
  5722. @item
  5723. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  5724. @example
  5725. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  5726. @end example
  5727. @end itemize
  5728. @section fftfilt
  5729. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  5730. @table @option
  5731. @item dc_Y
  5732. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  5733. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  5734. value is set to @code{0}.
  5735. @item dc_U
  5736. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  5737. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5738. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5739. @item dc_V
  5740. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  5741. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  5742. default value is set to @code{0}.
  5743. @item weight_Y
  5744. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  5745. @item weight_U
  5746. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  5747. @item weight_V
  5748. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  5749. The filter accepts the following variables:
  5750. @item X
  5751. @item Y
  5752. The coordinates of the current sample.
  5753. @item W
  5754. @item H
  5755. The width and height of the image.
  5756. @end table
  5757. @subsection Examples
  5758. @itemize
  5759. @item
  5760. High-pass:
  5761. @example
  5762. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5763. @end example
  5764. @item
  5765. Low-pass:
  5766. @example
  5767. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  5768. @end example
  5769. @item
  5770. Sharpen:
  5771. @example
  5772. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  5773. @end example
  5774. @item
  5775. Blur:
  5776. @example
  5777. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  5778. @end example
  5779. @end itemize
  5780. @section field
  5781. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  5782. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  5783. non-interlaced.
  5784. The filter accepts the following options:
  5785. @table @option
  5786. @item type
  5787. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  5788. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  5789. @code{bottom}).
  5790. @end table
  5791. @section fieldhint
  5792. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  5793. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  5794. @table @option
  5795. @item hint
  5796. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  5797. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  5798. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  5799. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  5800. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  5801. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  5802. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  5803. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  5804. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  5805. it will be marked same as input frame.
  5806. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  5807. @item mode
  5808. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  5809. @end table
  5810. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  5811. @example
  5812. 0,0 - # first frame
  5813. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  5814. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  5815. 1,0 -
  5816. 0,0 -
  5817. 0,0 -
  5818. 1,0 -
  5819. 1,0 -
  5820. 1,0 -
  5821. 0,0 -
  5822. 0,0 -
  5823. 1,0 -
  5824. 1,0 -
  5825. 1,0 -
  5826. 0,0 -
  5827. @end example
  5828. @section fieldmatch
  5829. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  5830. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  5831. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  5832. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  5833. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  5834. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  5835. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  5836. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  5837. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  5838. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  5839. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  5840. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  5841. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  5842. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  5843. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  5844. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  5845. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  5846. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  5847. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  5848. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  5849. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  5850. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  5851. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  5852. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  5853. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  5854. The filter accepts the following options:
  5855. @table @option
  5856. @item order
  5857. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  5858. @table @samp
  5859. @item auto
  5860. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  5861. @item bff
  5862. Assume bottom field first.
  5863. @item tff
  5864. Assume top field first.
  5865. @end table
  5866. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  5867. stream.
  5868. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5869. @item mode
  5870. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  5871. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  5872. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  5873. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  5874. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  5875. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  5876. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  5877. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  5878. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  5879. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  5880. Available values are:
  5881. @table @samp
  5882. @item pc
  5883. 2-way matching (p/c)
  5884. @item pc_n
  5885. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  5886. @item pc_u
  5887. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  5888. @item pc_n_ub
  5889. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  5890. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  5891. @item pcn
  5892. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  5893. @item pcn_ub
  5894. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  5895. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  5896. @end table
  5897. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  5898. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  5899. @var{top}).
  5900. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  5901. the slowest.
  5902. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  5903. @item ppsrc
  5904. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  5905. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  5906. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  5907. VFM/TFM.
  5908. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  5909. @item field
  5910. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  5911. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  5912. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  5913. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  5914. @table @samp
  5915. @item auto
  5916. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  5917. @item bottom
  5918. Match from the bottom field.
  5919. @item top
  5920. Match from the top field.
  5921. @end table
  5922. Default value is @var{auto}.
  5923. @item mchroma
  5924. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  5925. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  5926. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  5927. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  5928. the cost of some accuracy.
  5929. Default value is @code{1}.
  5930. @item y0
  5931. @item y1
  5932. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  5933. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  5934. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  5935. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  5936. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  5937. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  5938. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  5939. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  5940. @item scthresh
  5941. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  5942. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  5943. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  5944. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  5945. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  5946. @item combmatch
  5947. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  5948. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  5949. final match. Available values are:
  5950. @table @samp
  5951. @item none
  5952. No final matching based on combed scores.
  5953. @item sc
  5954. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  5955. @item full
  5956. Use combed scores all the time.
  5957. @end table
  5958. Default is @var{sc}.
  5959. @item combdbg
  5960. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  5961. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  5962. Available values are:
  5963. @table @samp
  5964. @item none
  5965. No forced calculation.
  5966. @item pcn
  5967. Force p/c/n calculations.
  5968. @item pcnub
  5969. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  5970. @end table
  5971. Default value is @var{none}.
  5972. @item cthresh
  5973. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  5974. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  5975. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  5976. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  5977. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  5978. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  5979. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  5980. Default value is @code{9}.
  5981. @item chroma
  5982. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  5983. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  5984. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  5985. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  5986. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  5987. Default value is @code{0}.
  5988. @item blockx
  5989. @item blocky
  5990. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  5991. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  5992. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  5993. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  5994. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  5995. to 512.
  5996. Default value is @code{16}.
  5997. @item combpel
  5998. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  5999. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  6000. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  6001. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  6002. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  6003. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  6004. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  6005. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  6006. Default value is @code{80}.
  6007. @end table
  6008. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  6009. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  6010. @subsubsection p/c/n
  6011. We assume the following telecined stream:
  6012. @example
  6013. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  6014. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  6015. @end example
  6016. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  6017. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  6018. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  6019. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  6020. @example
  6021. Input stream:
  6022. T 1 2 2 3 4
  6023. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  6024. Matches: c c n n c
  6025. Output stream:
  6026. T 1 2 3 4 4
  6027. B 1 2 3 4 4
  6028. @end example
  6029. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  6030. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  6031. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  6032. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  6033. looks like this:
  6034. @example
  6035. Input stream:
  6036. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  6037. B 1 2 3 4 4
  6038. Matches: c c p p c
  6039. Output stream:
  6040. T 1 2 2 3 4
  6041. B 1 2 2 3 4
  6042. @end example
  6043. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  6044. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  6045. @itemize
  6046. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  6047. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  6048. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  6049. @end itemize
  6050. @subsubsection u/b
  6051. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  6052. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  6053. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  6054. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  6055. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  6056. @example
  6057. Match: c p n b u
  6058. x x x x x
  6059. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  6060. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  6061. x x x x x
  6062. Output frames:
  6063. 2 1 2 2 2
  6064. 2 2 2 1 3
  6065. @end example
  6066. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  6067. @example
  6068. Match: c p n b u
  6069. x x x x x
  6070. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  6071. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  6072. x x x x x
  6073. Output frames:
  6074. 2 2 2 1 2
  6075. 2 1 3 2 2
  6076. @end example
  6077. @subsection Examples
  6078. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  6079. @example
  6080. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  6081. @end example
  6082. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  6083. @example
  6084. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  6085. @end example
  6086. @section fieldorder
  6087. Transform the field order of the input video.
  6088. It accepts the following parameters:
  6089. @table @option
  6090. @item order
  6091. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  6092. for bottom field first.
  6093. @end table
  6094. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  6095. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  6096. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  6097. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  6098. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  6099. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  6100. not alter the incoming video.
  6101. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  6102. which is bottom field first.
  6103. For example:
  6104. @example
  6105. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  6106. @end example
  6107. @section fifo, afifo
  6108. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  6109. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  6110. framework.
  6111. It does not take parameters.
  6112. @section find_rect
  6113. Find a rectangular object
  6114. It accepts the following options:
  6115. @table @option
  6116. @item object
  6117. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  6118. @item threshold
  6119. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  6120. @item mipmaps
  6121. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  6122. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  6123. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  6124. @end table
  6125. @subsection Examples
  6126. @itemize
  6127. @item
  6128. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6129. @example
  6130. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6131. @end example
  6132. @end itemize
  6133. @section cover_rect
  6134. Cover a rectangular object
  6135. It accepts the following options:
  6136. @table @option
  6137. @item cover
  6138. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6139. @item mode
  6140. Set covering mode.
  6141. It accepts the following values:
  6142. @table @samp
  6143. @item cover
  6144. cover it by the supplied image
  6145. @item blur
  6146. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6147. @end table
  6148. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6149. @end table
  6150. @subsection Examples
  6151. @itemize
  6152. @item
  6153. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6154. @example
  6155. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6156. @end example
  6157. @end itemize
  6158. @anchor{format}
  6159. @section format
  6160. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  6161. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  6162. the next filter.
  6163. It accepts the following parameters:
  6164. @table @option
  6165. @item pix_fmts
  6166. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  6167. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  6168. @end table
  6169. @subsection Examples
  6170. @itemize
  6171. @item
  6172. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  6173. @example
  6174. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  6175. @end example
  6176. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  6177. @example
  6178. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  6179. @end example
  6180. @end itemize
  6181. @anchor{fps}
  6182. @section fps
  6183. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  6184. frames as necessary.
  6185. It accepts the following parameters:
  6186. @table @option
  6187. @item fps
  6188. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  6189. @item round
  6190. Rounding method.
  6191. Possible values are:
  6192. @table @option
  6193. @item zero
  6194. zero round towards 0
  6195. @item inf
  6196. round away from 0
  6197. @item down
  6198. round towards -infinity
  6199. @item up
  6200. round towards +infinity
  6201. @item near
  6202. round to nearest
  6203. @end table
  6204. The default is @code{near}.
  6205. @item start_time
  6206. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  6207. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  6208. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  6209. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  6210. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  6211. frames with a negative PTS.
  6212. @end table
  6213. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  6214. @var{fps}[:@var{round}].
  6215. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  6216. @subsection Examples
  6217. @itemize
  6218. @item
  6219. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  6220. @example
  6221. fps=fps=25
  6222. @end example
  6223. @item
  6224. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  6225. @example
  6226. fps=fps=film:round=near
  6227. @end example
  6228. @end itemize
  6229. @section framepack
  6230. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  6231. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  6232. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  6233. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  6234. @ref{fps} filters.
  6235. It accepts the following parameters:
  6236. @table @option
  6237. @item format
  6238. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  6239. @table @option
  6240. @item sbs
  6241. The views are next to each other (default).
  6242. @item tab
  6243. The views are on top of each other.
  6244. @item lines
  6245. The views are packed by line.
  6246. @item columns
  6247. The views are packed by column.
  6248. @item frameseq
  6249. The views are temporally interleaved.
  6250. @end table
  6251. @end table
  6252. Some examples:
  6253. @example
  6254. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  6255. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  6256. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  6257. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  6258. @end example
  6259. @section framerate
  6260. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  6261. frames.
  6262. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  6263. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  6264. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  6265. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6266. @table @option
  6267. @item fps
  6268. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  6269. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  6270. @item interp_start
  6271. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  6272. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  6273. the default is @code{15}.
  6274. @item interp_end
  6275. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  6276. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  6277. the default is @code{240}.
  6278. @item scene
  6279. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  6280. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  6281. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  6282. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  6283. The default is @code{7}.
  6284. @item flags
  6285. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  6286. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  6287. @table @option
  6288. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  6289. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  6290. This flag is enabled by default.
  6291. @end table
  6292. @end table
  6293. @section framestep
  6294. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  6295. This filter accepts the following option:
  6296. @table @option
  6297. @item step
  6298. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  6299. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  6300. @end table
  6301. @anchor{frei0r}
  6302. @section frei0r
  6303. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  6304. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  6305. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  6306. It accepts the following parameters:
  6307. @table @option
  6308. @item filter_name
  6309. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  6310. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  6311. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREIOR_PATH}.
  6312. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  6313. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  6314. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  6315. @item filter_params
  6316. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  6317. @end table
  6318. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  6319. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  6320. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  6321. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or by a color description specified in the "Color"
  6322. section in the ffmpeg-utils manual), a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  6323. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  6324. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  6325. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  6326. @subsection Examples
  6327. @itemize
  6328. @item
  6329. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  6330. @example
  6331. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  6332. @end example
  6333. @item
  6334. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  6335. @example
  6336. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  6337. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  6338. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  6339. @end example
  6340. @item
  6341. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  6342. positions:
  6343. @example
  6344. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  6345. @end example
  6346. @end itemize
  6347. For more information, see
  6348. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  6349. @section fspp
  6350. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  6351. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  6352. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  6353. This allows for much higher speed.
  6354. The filter accepts the following options:
  6355. @table @option
  6356. @item quality
  6357. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  6358. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  6359. @item qp
  6360. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  6361. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  6362. @item strength
  6363. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  6364. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  6365. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  6366. @item use_bframe_qp
  6367. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  6368. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  6369. @code{0} (not enabled).
  6370. @end table
  6371. @section gblur
  6372. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  6373. The filter accepts the following options:
  6374. @table @option
  6375. @item sigma
  6376. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  6377. @item steps
  6378. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Defauls is @code{1}.
  6379. @item planes
  6380. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  6381. @item sigmaV
  6382. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  6383. Default is @code{-1}.
  6384. @end table
  6385. @section geq
  6386. The filter accepts the following options:
  6387. @table @option
  6388. @item lum_expr, lum
  6389. Set the luminance expression.
  6390. @item cb_expr, cb
  6391. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  6392. @item cr_expr, cr
  6393. Set the chrominance red expression.
  6394. @item alpha_expr, a
  6395. Set the alpha expression.
  6396. @item red_expr, r
  6397. Set the red expression.
  6398. @item green_expr, g
  6399. Set the green expression.
  6400. @item blue_expr, b
  6401. Set the blue expression.
  6402. @end table
  6403. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  6404. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  6405. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  6406. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  6407. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  6408. colorspace.
  6409. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  6410. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  6411. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  6412. to the luminance expression.
  6413. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  6414. @table @option
  6415. @item N
  6416. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  6417. @item X
  6418. @item Y
  6419. The coordinates of the current sample.
  6420. @item W
  6421. @item H
  6422. The width and height of the image.
  6423. @item SW
  6424. @item SH
  6425. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  6426. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  6427. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  6428. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  6429. @item T
  6430. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  6431. @item p(x, y)
  6432. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  6433. plane.
  6434. @item lum(x, y)
  6435. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  6436. plane.
  6437. @item cb(x, y)
  6438. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6439. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6440. @item cr(x, y)
  6441. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6442. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6443. @item r(x, y)
  6444. @item g(x, y)
  6445. @item b(x, y)
  6446. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  6447. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  6448. @item alpha(x, y)
  6449. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  6450. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  6451. @end table
  6452. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  6453. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  6454. @subsection Examples
  6455. @itemize
  6456. @item
  6457. Flip the image horizontally:
  6458. @example
  6459. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  6460. @end example
  6461. @item
  6462. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  6463. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  6464. @example
  6465. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  6466. @end example
  6467. @item
  6468. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  6469. @example
  6470. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  6471. @end example
  6472. @item
  6473. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  6474. @example
  6475. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  6476. @end example
  6477. @item
  6478. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  6479. @example
  6480. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  6481. @end example
  6482. @item
  6483. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  6484. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  6485. @example
  6486. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  6487. @end example
  6488. @end itemize
  6489. @section gradfun
  6490. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  6491. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  6492. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  6493. dither them.
  6494. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  6495. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  6496. bring back the bands.
  6497. It accepts the following parameters:
  6498. @table @option
  6499. @item strength
  6500. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  6501. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  6502. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  6503. valid range.
  6504. @item radius
  6505. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  6506. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  6507. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  6508. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  6509. @end table
  6510. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  6511. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  6512. @subsection Examples
  6513. @itemize
  6514. @item
  6515. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  6516. @example
  6517. gradfun=3.5:8
  6518. @end example
  6519. @item
  6520. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  6521. value):
  6522. @example
  6523. gradfun=radius=8
  6524. @end example
  6525. @end itemize
  6526. @anchor{haldclut}
  6527. @section haldclut
  6528. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  6529. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  6530. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  6531. The filter accepts the following options:
  6532. @table @option
  6533. @item shortest
  6534. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  6535. @item repeatlast
  6536. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  6537. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  6538. Default is @code{1}.
  6539. @end table
  6540. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  6541. filters share the same internals).
  6542. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  6543. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  6544. @subsection Workflow examples
  6545. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  6546. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  6547. @example
  6548. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  6549. @end example
  6550. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  6551. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  6552. @example
  6553. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  6554. @end example
  6555. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  6556. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  6557. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  6558. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  6559. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  6560. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  6561. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  6562. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  6563. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  6564. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  6565. @code{haldclut} filter:
  6566. @example
  6567. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  6568. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  6569. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  6570. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  6571. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  6572. @end example
  6573. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  6574. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  6575. the color changes.
  6576. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  6577. @example
  6578. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  6579. @end example
  6580. @section hflip
  6581. Flip the input video horizontally.
  6582. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  6583. @example
  6584. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  6585. @end example
  6586. @section histeq
  6587. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  6588. per-frame basis.
  6589. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  6590. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  6591. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  6592. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  6593. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  6594. video.
  6595. The filter accepts the following options:
  6596. @table @option
  6597. @item strength
  6598. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  6599. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  6600. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  6601. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  6602. @item intensity
  6603. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  6604. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  6605. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  6606. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  6607. @item antibanding
  6608. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  6609. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  6610. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  6611. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  6612. @end table
  6613. @section histogram
  6614. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  6615. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  6616. distribution in an image.
  6617. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  6618. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  6619. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  6620. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  6621. The filter accepts the following options:
  6622. @table @option
  6623. @item level_height
  6624. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  6625. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  6626. @item scale_height
  6627. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  6628. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  6629. @item display_mode
  6630. Set display mode.
  6631. It accepts the following values:
  6632. @table @samp
  6633. @item parade
  6634. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  6635. @item overlay
  6636. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  6637. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  6638. over one another.
  6639. @end table
  6640. Default is @code{parade}.
  6641. @item levels_mode
  6642. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  6643. Default is @code{linear}.
  6644. @item components
  6645. Set what color components to display.
  6646. Default is @code{7}.
  6647. @item fgopacity
  6648. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  6649. @item bgopacity
  6650. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  6651. @end table
  6652. @subsection Examples
  6653. @itemize
  6654. @item
  6655. Calculate and draw histogram:
  6656. @example
  6657. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  6658. @end example
  6659. @end itemize
  6660. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  6661. @section hqdn3d
  6662. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  6663. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  6664. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  6665. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6666. @table @option
  6667. @item luma_spatial
  6668. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  6669. It defaults to 4.0.
  6670. @item chroma_spatial
  6671. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  6672. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6673. @item luma_tmp
  6674. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6675. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  6676. @item chroma_tmp
  6677. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  6678. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  6679. @end table
  6680. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  6681. @section hwupload_cuda
  6682. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  6683. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6684. @table @option
  6685. @item device
  6686. The number of the CUDA device to use
  6687. @end table
  6688. @section hqx
  6689. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  6690. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  6691. It accepts the following option:
  6692. @table @option
  6693. @item n
  6694. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  6695. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  6696. Default is @code{3}.
  6697. @end table
  6698. @section hstack
  6699. Stack input videos horizontally.
  6700. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  6701. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  6702. to create same output.
  6703. The filter accept the following option:
  6704. @table @option
  6705. @item inputs
  6706. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  6707. @item shortest
  6708. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  6709. terminates. Default value is 0.
  6710. @end table
  6711. @section hue
  6712. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  6713. It accepts the following parameters:
  6714. @table @option
  6715. @item h
  6716. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  6717. and defaults to "0".
  6718. @item s
  6719. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6720. defaults to "1".
  6721. @item H
  6722. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  6723. expression, and defaults to "0".
  6724. @item b
  6725. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  6726. defaults to "0".
  6727. @end table
  6728. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  6729. specified at the same time.
  6730. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  6731. expressions containing the following constants:
  6732. @table @option
  6733. @item n
  6734. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  6735. @item pts
  6736. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  6737. @item r
  6738. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  6739. @item t
  6740. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  6741. @item tb
  6742. time base of the input video
  6743. @end table
  6744. @subsection Examples
  6745. @itemize
  6746. @item
  6747. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  6748. @example
  6749. hue=h=90:s=1
  6750. @end example
  6751. @item
  6752. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  6753. @example
  6754. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  6755. @end example
  6756. @item
  6757. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  6758. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  6759. @example
  6760. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  6761. @end example
  6762. @item
  6763. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  6764. @example
  6765. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  6766. @end example
  6767. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  6768. @example
  6769. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  6770. @end example
  6771. @item
  6772. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  6773. @example
  6774. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  6775. @end example
  6776. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  6777. @example
  6778. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  6779. @end example
  6780. @end itemize
  6781. @subsection Commands
  6782. This filter supports the following commands:
  6783. @table @option
  6784. @item b
  6785. @item s
  6786. @item h
  6787. @item H
  6788. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  6789. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6790. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6791. value.
  6792. @end table
  6793. @section hysteresis
  6794. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  6795. This allows to build more robust edge masks.
  6796. This filter accepts the following options:
  6797. @table @option
  6798. @item planes
  6799. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  6800. copied from first stream.
  6801. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  6802. @item threshold
  6803. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  6804. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  6805. By default value is 0.
  6806. @end table
  6807. @section idet
  6808. Detect video interlacing type.
  6809. This filter tries to detect if the input frames as interlaced, progressive,
  6810. top or bottom field first. It will also try and detect fields that are
  6811. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  6812. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  6813. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  6814. The filter will log these metadata values:
  6815. @table @option
  6816. @item single.current_frame
  6817. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  6818. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6819. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6820. @item single.tff
  6821. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  6822. @item multiple.tff
  6823. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6824. @item single.bff
  6825. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  6826. @item multiple.current_frame
  6827. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  6828. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  6829. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  6830. @item multiple.bff
  6831. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  6832. @item single.progressive
  6833. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  6834. @item multiple.progressive
  6835. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  6836. @item single.undetermined
  6837. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  6838. @item multiple.undetermined
  6839. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  6840. @item repeated.current_frame
  6841. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  6842. @item repeated.neither
  6843. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  6844. @item repeated.top
  6845. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  6846. @item repeated.bottom
  6847. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  6848. @end table
  6849. The filter accepts the following options:
  6850. @table @option
  6851. @item intl_thres
  6852. Set interlacing threshold.
  6853. @item prog_thres
  6854. Set progressive threshold.
  6855. @item rep_thres
  6856. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  6857. @item half_life
  6858. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  6859. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to it's
  6860. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  6861. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  6862. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  6863. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  6864. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  6865. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  6866. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  6867. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  6868. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  6869. @end table
  6870. @section il
  6871. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  6872. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  6873. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  6874. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  6875. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  6876. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  6877. The filter accepts the following options:
  6878. @table @option
  6879. @item luma_mode, l
  6880. @item chroma_mode, c
  6881. @item alpha_mode, a
  6882. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  6883. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  6884. @table @samp
  6885. @item none
  6886. Do nothing.
  6887. @item deinterleave, d
  6888. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  6889. @item interleave, i
  6890. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  6891. @end table
  6892. Default value is @code{none}.
  6893. @item luma_swap, ls
  6894. @item chroma_swap, cs
  6895. @item alpha_swap, as
  6896. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  6897. @end table
  6898. @section inflate
  6899. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  6900. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6901. only values higher than the pixel.
  6902. It accepts the following options:
  6903. @table @option
  6904. @item threshold0
  6905. @item threshold1
  6906. @item threshold2
  6907. @item threshold3
  6908. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6909. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6910. @end table
  6911. @section interlace
  6912. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  6913. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  6914. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  6915. @example
  6916. Original Original New Frame
  6917. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  6918. ========== =========== ==================
  6919. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  6920. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  6921. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  6922. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  6923. ... ... ...
  6924. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  6925. @end example
  6926. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  6927. @table @option
  6928. @item scan
  6929. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  6930. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  6931. @item lowpass
  6932. Enable (default) or disable the vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter
  6933. interlacing and reduce moire patterns.
  6934. @end table
  6935. @section kerndeint
  6936. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  6937. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  6938. progressive frames.
  6939. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  6940. @table @option
  6941. @item thresh
  6942. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  6943. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  6944. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  6945. applying the process on every pixels.
  6946. @item map
  6947. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  6948. Default is 0.
  6949. @item order
  6950. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  6951. 0. Default is 0.
  6952. @item sharp
  6953. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6954. @item twoway
  6955. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  6956. @end table
  6957. @subsection Examples
  6958. @itemize
  6959. @item
  6960. Apply default values:
  6961. @example
  6962. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  6963. @end example
  6964. @item
  6965. Enable additional sharpening:
  6966. @example
  6967. kerndeint=sharp=1
  6968. @end example
  6969. @item
  6970. Paint processed pixels in white:
  6971. @example
  6972. kerndeint=map=1
  6973. @end example
  6974. @end itemize
  6975. @section lenscorrection
  6976. Correct radial lens distortion
  6977. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  6978. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  6979. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  6980. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  6981. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  6982. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  6983. Digikam from the KDE project.
  6984. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  6985. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  6986. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  6987. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  6988. be applied before or after lens correction.
  6989. @subsection Options
  6990. The filter accepts the following options:
  6991. @table @option
  6992. @item cx
  6993. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  6994. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  6995. width.
  6996. @item cy
  6997. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  6998. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  6999. height.
  7000. @item k1
  7001. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  7002. @item k2
  7003. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
  7004. @end table
  7005. The formula that generates the correction is:
  7006. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  7007. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  7008. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  7009. @section loop
  7010. Loop video frames.
  7011. The filter accepts the following options:
  7012. @table @option
  7013. @item loop
  7014. Set the number of loops.
  7015. @item size
  7016. Set maximal size in number of frames.
  7017. @item start
  7018. Set first frame of loop.
  7019. @end table
  7020. @anchor{lut3d}
  7021. @section lut3d
  7022. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  7023. The filter accepts the following options:
  7024. @table @option
  7025. @item file
  7026. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  7027. Currently supported formats:
  7028. @table @samp
  7029. @item 3dl
  7030. AfterEffects
  7031. @item cube
  7032. Iridas
  7033. @item dat
  7034. DaVinci
  7035. @item m3d
  7036. Pandora
  7037. @end table
  7038. @item interp
  7039. Select interpolation mode.
  7040. Available values are:
  7041. @table @samp
  7042. @item nearest
  7043. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  7044. @item trilinear
  7045. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  7046. @item tetrahedral
  7047. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  7048. @end table
  7049. @end table
  7050. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  7051. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  7052. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  7053. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  7054. to an RGB input video.
  7055. These filters accept the following parameters:
  7056. @table @option
  7057. @item c0
  7058. set first pixel component expression
  7059. @item c1
  7060. set second pixel component expression
  7061. @item c2
  7062. set third pixel component expression
  7063. @item c3
  7064. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  7065. @item r
  7066. set red component expression
  7067. @item g
  7068. set green component expression
  7069. @item b
  7070. set blue component expression
  7071. @item a
  7072. alpha component expression
  7073. @item y
  7074. set Y/luminance component expression
  7075. @item u
  7076. set U/Cb component expression
  7077. @item v
  7078. set V/Cr component expression
  7079. @end table
  7080. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  7081. the corresponding pixel component values.
  7082. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  7083. format in input.
  7084. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  7085. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  7086. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  7087. @table @option
  7088. @item w
  7089. @item h
  7090. The input width and height.
  7091. @item val
  7092. The input value for the pixel component.
  7093. @item clipval
  7094. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  7095. @item maxval
  7096. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  7097. @item minval
  7098. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  7099. @item negval
  7100. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  7101. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  7102. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  7103. @item clip(val)
  7104. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  7105. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  7106. @item gammaval(gamma)
  7107. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  7108. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  7109. expression
  7110. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  7111. @end table
  7112. All expressions default to "val".
  7113. @subsection Examples
  7114. @itemize
  7115. @item
  7116. Negate input video:
  7117. @example
  7118. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  7119. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  7120. @end example
  7121. The above is the same as:
  7122. @example
  7123. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  7124. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  7125. @end example
  7126. @item
  7127. Negate luminance:
  7128. @example
  7129. lutyuv=y=negval
  7130. @end example
  7131. @item
  7132. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  7133. @example
  7134. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  7135. @end example
  7136. @item
  7137. Apply a luma burning effect:
  7138. @example
  7139. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  7140. @end example
  7141. @item
  7142. Remove green and blue components:
  7143. @example
  7144. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  7145. @end example
  7146. @item
  7147. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  7148. @example
  7149. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  7150. @end example
  7151. @item
  7152. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  7153. @example
  7154. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  7155. @end example
  7156. @item
  7157. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  7158. @example
  7159. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  7160. @end example
  7161. @item
  7162. Technicolor like effect:
  7163. @example
  7164. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  7165. @end example
  7166. @end itemize
  7167. @section lut2
  7168. Compute and apply a lookup table from two video inputs.
  7169. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  7170. @table @option
  7171. @item c0
  7172. set first pixel component expression
  7173. @item c1
  7174. set second pixel component expression
  7175. @item c2
  7176. set third pixel component expression
  7177. @item c3
  7178. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  7179. @end table
  7180. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  7181. the corresponding pixel component values.
  7182. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  7183. format in inputs.
  7184. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  7185. @table @option
  7186. @item w
  7187. @item h
  7188. The input width and height.
  7189. @item x
  7190. The first input value for the pixel component.
  7191. @item y
  7192. The second input value for the pixel component.
  7193. @end table
  7194. All expressions default to "x".
  7195. @section maskedclamp
  7196. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  7197. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  7198. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  7199. This filter accepts the following options:
  7200. @table @option
  7201. @item undershoot
  7202. Default value is @code{0}.
  7203. @item overshoot
  7204. Default value is @code{0}.
  7205. @item planes
  7206. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  7207. copied from first stream.
  7208. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  7209. @end table
  7210. @section maskedmerge
  7211. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  7212. weights in the third input stream.
  7213. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  7214. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  7215. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  7216. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  7217. input stream's pixel components.
  7218. This filter accepts the following options:
  7219. @table @option
  7220. @item planes
  7221. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  7222. copied from first stream.
  7223. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  7224. @end table
  7225. @section mcdeint
  7226. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  7227. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  7228. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  7229. This filter accepts the following options:
  7230. @table @option
  7231. @item mode
  7232. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  7233. It accepts one of the following values:
  7234. @table @samp
  7235. @item fast
  7236. @item medium
  7237. @item slow
  7238. use iterative motion estimation
  7239. @item extra_slow
  7240. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  7241. @end table
  7242. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  7243. @item parity
  7244. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  7245. one of the following values:
  7246. @table @samp
  7247. @item 0, tff
  7248. assume top field first
  7249. @item 1, bff
  7250. assume bottom field first
  7251. @end table
  7252. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  7253. @item qp
  7254. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  7255. encoder.
  7256. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  7257. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  7258. @end table
  7259. @section mergeplanes
  7260. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  7261. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  7262. planes to the output video.
  7263. This filter accepts the following options:
  7264. @table @option
  7265. @item mapping
  7266. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  7267. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  7268. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  7269. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  7270. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  7271. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  7272. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  7273. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  7274. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  7275. @item format
  7276. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  7277. @end table
  7278. @subsection Examples
  7279. @itemize
  7280. @item
  7281. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  7282. @example
  7283. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  7284. @end example
  7285. @item
  7286. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  7287. @example
  7288. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  7289. @end example
  7290. @item
  7291. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  7292. @example
  7293. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  7294. @end example
  7295. @item
  7296. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  7297. @example
  7298. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  7299. @end example
  7300. @item
  7301. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  7302. @example
  7303. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  7304. @end example
  7305. @end itemize
  7306. @section mestimate
  7307. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  7308. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  7309. This filter accepts the following options:
  7310. @table @option
  7311. @item method
  7312. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  7313. @table @samp
  7314. @item esa
  7315. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  7316. @item tss
  7317. Three step search algorithm.
  7318. @item tdls
  7319. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  7320. @item ntss
  7321. New three step search algorithm.
  7322. @item fss
  7323. Four step search algorithm.
  7324. @item ds
  7325. Diamond search algorithm.
  7326. @item hexbs
  7327. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  7328. @item epzs
  7329. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  7330. @item umh
  7331. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  7332. @end table
  7333. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  7334. @item mb_size
  7335. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  7336. @item search_param
  7337. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  7338. @end table
  7339. @section minterpolate
  7340. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  7341. This filter accepts the following options:
  7342. @table @option
  7343. @item fps
  7344. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  7345. @item mi_mode
  7346. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7347. @table @samp
  7348. @item dup
  7349. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  7350. @item blend
  7351. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  7352. @item mci
  7353. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  7354. @table @samp
  7355. @item mc_mode
  7356. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7357. @table @samp
  7358. @item obmc
  7359. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  7360. @item aobmc
  7361. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  7362. @end table
  7363. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  7364. @item me_mode
  7365. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  7366. @table @samp
  7367. @item bidir
  7368. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  7369. @item bilat
  7370. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  7371. @end table
  7372. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  7373. @item me
  7374. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  7375. @table @samp
  7376. @item esa
  7377. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  7378. @item tss
  7379. Three step search algorithm.
  7380. @item tdls
  7381. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  7382. @item ntss
  7383. New three step search algorithm.
  7384. @item fss
  7385. Four step search algorithm.
  7386. @item ds
  7387. Diamond search algorithm.
  7388. @item hexbs
  7389. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  7390. @item epzs
  7391. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  7392. @item umh
  7393. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  7394. @end table
  7395. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  7396. @item mb_size
  7397. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  7398. @item search_param
  7399. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  7400. @item vsmbc
  7401. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  7402. @end table
  7403. @end table
  7404. @item scd
  7405. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  7406. @table @samp
  7407. @item none
  7408. Disable scene change detection.
  7409. @item fdiff
  7410. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it statisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  7411. @end table
  7412. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  7413. @item scd_threshold
  7414. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  7415. @end table
  7416. @section mpdecimate
  7417. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  7418. order to reduce frame rate.
  7419. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  7420. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  7421. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  7422. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7423. @table @option
  7424. @item max
  7425. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  7426. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  7427. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped unregarding the
  7428. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  7429. Default value is 0.
  7430. @item hi
  7431. @item lo
  7432. @item frac
  7433. Set the dropping threshold values.
  7434. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  7435. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  7436. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  7437. out differently over the block.
  7438. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  7439. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  7440. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  7441. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  7442. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  7443. @end table
  7444. @section negate
  7445. Negate input video.
  7446. It accepts an integer in input; if non-zero it negates the
  7447. alpha component (if available). The default value in input is 0.
  7448. @section nnedi
  7449. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  7450. This filter accepts the following options:
  7451. @table @option
  7452. @item weights
  7453. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  7454. Currently file can be found here:
  7455. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  7456. @item deint
  7457. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  7458. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  7459. @item field
  7460. Set mode of operation.
  7461. Can be one of the following:
  7462. @table @samp
  7463. @item af
  7464. Use frame flags, both fields.
  7465. @item a
  7466. Use frame flags, single field.
  7467. @item t
  7468. Use top field only.
  7469. @item b
  7470. Use bottom field only.
  7471. @item tf
  7472. Use both fields, top first.
  7473. @item bf
  7474. Use both fields, bottom first.
  7475. @end table
  7476. @item planes
  7477. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  7478. @item nsize
  7479. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  7480. network.
  7481. Can be one of the following:
  7482. @table @samp
  7483. @item s8x6
  7484. @item s16x6
  7485. @item s32x6
  7486. @item s48x6
  7487. @item s8x4
  7488. @item s16x4
  7489. @item s32x4
  7490. @end table
  7491. @item nns
  7492. Set the number of neurons in predicctor neural network.
  7493. Can be one of the following:
  7494. @table @samp
  7495. @item n16
  7496. @item n32
  7497. @item n64
  7498. @item n128
  7499. @item n256
  7500. @end table
  7501. @item qual
  7502. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  7503. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  7504. @code{slow}.
  7505. @item etype
  7506. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  7507. Can be one of the following:
  7508. @table @samp
  7509. @item a
  7510. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  7511. @item s
  7512. weights trained to minimize squared error
  7513. @end table
  7514. @item pscrn
  7515. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  7516. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  7517. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  7518. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  7519. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  7520. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  7521. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  7522. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  7523. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  7524. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  7525. Can be one of the following:
  7526. @table @samp
  7527. @item none
  7528. @item original
  7529. @item new
  7530. @end table
  7531. Default is @code{new}.
  7532. @item fapprox
  7533. Set various debugging flags.
  7534. @end table
  7535. @section noformat
  7536. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  7537. input to the next filter.
  7538. It accepts the following parameters:
  7539. @table @option
  7540. @item pix_fmts
  7541. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  7542. apix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  7543. @end table
  7544. @subsection Examples
  7545. @itemize
  7546. @item
  7547. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  7548. input to the vflip filter:
  7549. @example
  7550. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  7551. @end example
  7552. @item
  7553. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  7554. @example
  7555. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  7556. @end example
  7557. @end itemize
  7558. @section noise
  7559. Add noise on video input frame.
  7560. The filter accepts the following options:
  7561. @table @option
  7562. @item all_seed
  7563. @item c0_seed
  7564. @item c1_seed
  7565. @item c2_seed
  7566. @item c3_seed
  7567. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  7568. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  7569. @item all_strength, alls
  7570. @item c0_strength, c0s
  7571. @item c1_strength, c1s
  7572. @item c2_strength, c2s
  7573. @item c3_strength, c3s
  7574. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  7575. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  7576. @item all_flags, allf
  7577. @item c0_flags, c0f
  7578. @item c1_flags, c1f
  7579. @item c2_flags, c2f
  7580. @item c3_flags, c3f
  7581. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  7582. Available values for component flags are:
  7583. @table @samp
  7584. @item a
  7585. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  7586. @item p
  7587. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  7588. @item t
  7589. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  7590. @item u
  7591. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  7592. @end table
  7593. @end table
  7594. @subsection Examples
  7595. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  7596. @example
  7597. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  7598. @end example
  7599. @section null
  7600. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  7601. @section ocr
  7602. Optical Character Recognition
  7603. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition.
  7604. It accepts the following options:
  7605. @table @option
  7606. @item datapath
  7607. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  7608. set at installation.
  7609. @item language
  7610. Set language, default is "eng".
  7611. @item whitelist
  7612. Set character whitelist.
  7613. @item blacklist
  7614. Set character blacklist.
  7615. @end table
  7616. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  7617. @section ocv
  7618. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  7619. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  7620. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  7621. It accepts the following parameters:
  7622. @table @option
  7623. @item filter_name
  7624. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  7625. @item filter_params
  7626. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  7627. values are assumed.
  7628. @end table
  7629. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  7630. information:
  7631. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  7632. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  7633. @anchor{dilate}
  7634. @subsection dilate
  7635. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  7636. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  7637. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  7638. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  7639. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  7640. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  7641. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  7642. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  7643. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  7644. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  7645. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  7646. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  7647. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  7648. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  7649. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  7650. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  7651. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  7652. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  7653. Some examples:
  7654. @example
  7655. # Use the default values
  7656. ocv=dilate
  7657. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  7658. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  7659. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  7660. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  7661. # *
  7662. # ***
  7663. # *****
  7664. # ***
  7665. # *
  7666. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  7667. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  7668. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  7669. @end example
  7670. @subsection erode
  7671. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  7672. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  7673. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  7674. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  7675. @subsection smooth
  7676. Smooth the input video.
  7677. The filter takes the following parameters:
  7678. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  7679. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  7680. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  7681. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  7682. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  7683. depend on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  7684. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  7685. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  7686. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  7687. other parameters is 0.
  7688. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  7689. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  7690. @anchor{overlay}
  7691. @section overlay
  7692. Overlay one video on top of another.
  7693. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  7694. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  7695. It accepts the following parameters:
  7696. A description of the accepted options follows.
  7697. @table @option
  7698. @item x
  7699. @item y
  7700. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  7701. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  7702. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  7703. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  7704. @item eof_action
  7705. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  7706. one of the following values:
  7707. @table @option
  7708. @item repeat
  7709. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  7710. @item endall
  7711. End both streams.
  7712. @item pass
  7713. Pass the main input through.
  7714. @end table
  7715. @item eval
  7716. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  7717. It accepts the following values:
  7718. @table @samp
  7719. @item init
  7720. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7721. when a command is processed
  7722. @item frame
  7723. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7724. @end table
  7725. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  7726. @item shortest
  7727. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  7728. terminates. Default value is 0.
  7729. @item format
  7730. Set the format for the output video.
  7731. It accepts the following values:
  7732. @table @samp
  7733. @item yuv420
  7734. force YUV420 output
  7735. @item yuv422
  7736. force YUV422 output
  7737. @item yuv444
  7738. force YUV444 output
  7739. @item rgb
  7740. force RGB output
  7741. @end table
  7742. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  7743. @item rgb @emph{(deprecated)}
  7744. If set to 1, force the filter to accept inputs in the RGB
  7745. color space. Default value is 0. This option is deprecated, use
  7746. @option{format} instead.
  7747. @item repeatlast
  7748. If set to 1, force the filter to draw the last overlay frame over the
  7749. main input until the end of the stream. A value of 0 disables this
  7750. behavior. Default value is 1.
  7751. @end table
  7752. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  7753. parameters.
  7754. @table @option
  7755. @item main_w, W
  7756. @item main_h, H
  7757. The main input width and height.
  7758. @item overlay_w, w
  7759. @item overlay_h, h
  7760. The overlay input width and height.
  7761. @item x
  7762. @item y
  7763. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  7764. each new frame.
  7765. @item hsub
  7766. @item vsub
  7767. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  7768. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  7769. @var{vsub} is 1.
  7770. @item n
  7771. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7772. @item pos
  7773. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  7774. @item t
  7775. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  7776. @end table
  7777. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  7778. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  7779. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  7780. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  7781. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  7782. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  7783. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  7784. the @var{movie} filter does.
  7785. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  7786. efficiency of such approach.
  7787. @subsection Commands
  7788. This filter supports the following commands:
  7789. @table @option
  7790. @item x
  7791. @item y
  7792. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  7793. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7794. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7795. value.
  7796. @end table
  7797. @subsection Examples
  7798. @itemize
  7799. @item
  7800. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  7801. video:
  7802. @example
  7803. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  7804. @end example
  7805. Using named options the example above becomes:
  7806. @example
  7807. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  7808. @end example
  7809. @item
  7810. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  7811. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  7812. @example
  7813. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  7814. @end example
  7815. @item
  7816. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  7817. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  7818. @example
  7819. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  7820. @end example
  7821. @item
  7822. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  7823. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  7824. @example
  7825. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  7826. @end example
  7827. @item
  7828. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  7829. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  7830. @example
  7831. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  7832. @end example
  7833. The above command is the same as:
  7834. @example
  7835. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  7836. @end example
  7837. @item
  7838. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  7839. screen starting since time 2:
  7840. @example
  7841. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  7842. @end example
  7843. @item
  7844. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  7845. @example
  7846. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  7847. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  7848. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  7849. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  7850. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  7851. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  7852. "
  7853. @end example
  7854. @item
  7855. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  7856. @example
  7857. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  7858. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  7859. masked.avi
  7860. @end example
  7861. @item
  7862. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  7863. @example
  7864. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  7865. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  7866. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  7867. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  7868. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  7869. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  7870. @end example
  7871. @end itemize
  7872. @section owdenoise
  7873. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  7874. The filter accepts the following options:
  7875. @table @option
  7876. @item depth
  7877. Set depth.
  7878. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  7879. slow down filtering.
  7880. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  7881. @item luma_strength, ls
  7882. Set luma strength.
  7883. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7884. @item chroma_strength, cs
  7885. Set chroma strength.
  7886. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  7887. @end table
  7888. @anchor{pad}
  7889. @section pad
  7890. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  7891. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  7892. It accepts the following parameters:
  7893. @table @option
  7894. @item width, w
  7895. @item height, h
  7896. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  7897. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  7898. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  7899. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  7900. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  7901. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  7902. @item x
  7903. @item y
  7904. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  7905. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  7906. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  7907. expression, and vice versa.
  7908. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  7909. @item color
  7910. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  7911. check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
  7912. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  7913. @end table
  7914. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  7915. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  7916. @table @option
  7917. @item in_w
  7918. @item in_h
  7919. The input video width and height.
  7920. @item iw
  7921. @item ih
  7922. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  7923. @item out_w
  7924. @item out_h
  7925. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  7926. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  7927. @item ow
  7928. @item oh
  7929. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  7930. @item x
  7931. @item y
  7932. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  7933. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  7934. @item a
  7935. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  7936. @item sar
  7937. input sample aspect ratio
  7938. @item dar
  7939. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  7940. @item hsub
  7941. @item vsub
  7942. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7943. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7944. @end table
  7945. @subsection Examples
  7946. @itemize
  7947. @item
  7948. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  7949. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  7950. column 0, row 40
  7951. @example
  7952. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  7953. @end example
  7954. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  7955. @example
  7956. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  7957. @end example
  7958. @item
  7959. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  7960. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  7961. @example
  7962. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7963. @end example
  7964. @item
  7965. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  7966. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  7967. the center of the padded area:
  7968. @example
  7969. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7970. @end example
  7971. @item
  7972. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  7973. @example
  7974. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7975. @end example
  7976. @item
  7977. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  7978. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  7979. according to the relation:
  7980. @example
  7981. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  7982. X = output_dar / sar
  7983. @end example
  7984. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  7985. @example
  7986. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  7987. @end example
  7988. @item
  7989. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  7990. corner of the output padded area:
  7991. @example
  7992. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  7993. @end example
  7994. @end itemize
  7995. @anchor{palettegen}
  7996. @section palettegen
  7997. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  7998. It accepts the following options:
  7999. @table @option
  8000. @item max_colors
  8001. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  8002. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  8003. will be black.
  8004. @item reserve_transparent
  8005. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  8006. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  8007. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  8008. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  8009. Set by default.
  8010. @item stats_mode
  8011. Set statistics mode.
  8012. It accepts the following values:
  8013. @table @samp
  8014. @item full
  8015. Compute full frame histograms.
  8016. @item diff
  8017. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  8018. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  8019. the background is static.
  8020. @end table
  8021. Default value is @var{full}.
  8022. @end table
  8023. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  8024. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  8025. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  8026. @var{info} logging level.
  8027. @subsection Examples
  8028. @itemize
  8029. @item
  8030. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8031. @example
  8032. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  8033. @end example
  8034. @end itemize
  8035. @section paletteuse
  8036. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  8037. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  8038. be a 256 pixels image.
  8039. It accepts the following options:
  8040. @table @option
  8041. @item dither
  8042. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  8043. @table @samp
  8044. @item bayer
  8045. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  8046. @item heckbert
  8047. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  8048. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  8049. reference.
  8050. @item floyd_steinberg
  8051. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  8052. @item sierra2
  8053. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  8054. @item sierra2_4a
  8055. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  8056. @end table
  8057. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  8058. @item bayer_scale
  8059. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  8060. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  8061. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  8062. at the cost of more banding.
  8063. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  8064. @item diff_mode
  8065. If set, define the zone to process
  8066. @table @samp
  8067. @item rectangle
  8068. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  8069. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  8070. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  8071. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  8072. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  8073. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  8074. @end table
  8075. Default is @var{none}.
  8076. @end table
  8077. @subsection Examples
  8078. @itemize
  8079. @item
  8080. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  8081. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8082. @example
  8083. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  8084. @end example
  8085. @end itemize
  8086. @section perspective
  8087. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  8088. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8089. @table @option
  8090. @item x0
  8091. @item y0
  8092. @item x1
  8093. @item y1
  8094. @item x2
  8095. @item y2
  8096. @item x3
  8097. @item y3
  8098. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  8099. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  8100. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  8101. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  8102. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  8103. The expressions can use the following variables:
  8104. @table @option
  8105. @item W
  8106. @item H
  8107. the width and height of video frame.
  8108. @item in
  8109. Input frame count.
  8110. @item on
  8111. Output frame count.
  8112. @end table
  8113. @item interpolation
  8114. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  8115. It accepts the following values:
  8116. @table @samp
  8117. @item linear
  8118. @item cubic
  8119. @end table
  8120. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  8121. @item sense
  8122. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  8123. It accepts the following values:
  8124. @table @samp
  8125. @item 0, source
  8126. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  8127. the corners of the destination.
  8128. @item 1, destination
  8129. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  8130. by the given coordinates.
  8131. Default value is @samp{source}.
  8132. @end table
  8133. @item eval
  8134. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  8135. It accepts the following values:
  8136. @table @samp
  8137. @item init
  8138. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  8139. when a command is processed
  8140. @item frame
  8141. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  8142. @end table
  8143. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8144. @end table
  8145. @section phase
  8146. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  8147. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  8148. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  8149. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8150. @table @option
  8151. @item mode
  8152. Set phase mode.
  8153. It accepts the following values:
  8154. @table @samp
  8155. @item t
  8156. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  8157. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  8158. @item b
  8159. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  8160. Filter will delay the top field.
  8161. @item p
  8162. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  8163. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  8164. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  8165. @item a
  8166. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  8167. opposite.
  8168. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  8169. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  8170. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  8171. @item u
  8172. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  8173. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  8174. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  8175. match between the fields.
  8176. @item T
  8177. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  8178. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  8179. @item B
  8180. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  8181. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  8182. @item A
  8183. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  8184. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  8185. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  8186. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  8187. @item U
  8188. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  8189. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  8190. @end table
  8191. @end table
  8192. @section pixdesctest
  8193. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  8194. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  8195. For example:
  8196. @example
  8197. format=monow, pixdesctest
  8198. @end example
  8199. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  8200. @section pp
  8201. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  8202. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  8203. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  8204. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  8205. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  8206. The filters accept the following options:
  8207. @table @option
  8208. @item subfilters
  8209. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  8210. @end table
  8211. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  8212. @table @option
  8213. @item a/autoq
  8214. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  8215. @item c/chrom
  8216. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  8217. @item y/nochrom
  8218. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  8219. @item n/noluma
  8220. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  8221. @end table
  8222. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  8223. Available subfilters are:
  8224. @table @option
  8225. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8226. Horizontal deblocking filter
  8227. @table @option
  8228. @item difference
  8229. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8230. @item flatness
  8231. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8232. @end table
  8233. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8234. Vertical deblocking filter
  8235. @table @option
  8236. @item difference
  8237. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8238. @item flatness
  8239. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8240. @end table
  8241. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8242. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  8243. @table @option
  8244. @item difference
  8245. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8246. @item flatness
  8247. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8248. @end table
  8249. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  8250. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  8251. @table @option
  8252. @item difference
  8253. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  8254. @item flatness
  8255. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  8256. @end table
  8257. @end table
  8258. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  8259. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  8260. thresholds.
  8261. @table @option
  8262. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  8263. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  8264. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  8265. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  8266. @item dr/dering
  8267. Deringing filter
  8268. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  8269. @table @option
  8270. @item threshold1
  8271. larger -> stronger filtering
  8272. @item threshold2
  8273. larger -> stronger filtering
  8274. @item threshold3
  8275. larger -> stronger filtering
  8276. @end table
  8277. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  8278. @table @option
  8279. @item f/fullyrange
  8280. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  8281. @end table
  8282. @item lb/linblenddeint
  8283. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  8284. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  8285. @item li/linipoldeint
  8286. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  8287. linearly interpolating every second line.
  8288. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  8289. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  8290. cubically interpolating every second line.
  8291. @item md/mediandeint
  8292. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  8293. median filter to every second line.
  8294. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  8295. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  8296. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  8297. @item l5/lowpass5
  8298. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  8299. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  8300. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  8301. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  8302. specify.
  8303. @table @option
  8304. @item quantizer
  8305. Quantizer to use
  8306. @end table
  8307. @item de/default
  8308. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  8309. @item fa/fast
  8310. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  8311. @item ac
  8312. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  8313. @end table
  8314. @subsection Examples
  8315. @itemize
  8316. @item
  8317. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  8318. brightness/contrast:
  8319. @example
  8320. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  8321. @end example
  8322. @item
  8323. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  8324. @example
  8325. pp=de/-al
  8326. @end example
  8327. @item
  8328. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  8329. @example
  8330. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  8331. @end example
  8332. @item
  8333. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  8334. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  8335. @example
  8336. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  8337. @end example
  8338. @end itemize
  8339. @section pp7
  8340. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  8341. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  8342. used after IDCT.
  8343. The filter accepts the following options:
  8344. @table @option
  8345. @item qp
  8346. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  8347. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  8348. (if available).
  8349. @item mode
  8350. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  8351. @table @samp
  8352. @item hard
  8353. Set hard thresholding.
  8354. @item soft
  8355. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  8356. @item medium
  8357. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  8358. @end table
  8359. @end table
  8360. @section psnr
  8361. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  8362. Ratio) between two input videos.
  8363. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  8364. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  8365. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  8366. the PSNR.
  8367. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  8368. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  8369. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  8370. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  8371. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  8372. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  8373. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  8374. @example
  8375. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  8376. @end example
  8377. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  8378. image.
  8379. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  8380. @table @option
  8381. @item stats_file, f
  8382. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  8383. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  8384. standard output.
  8385. @item stats_version
  8386. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  8387. each format are written below.
  8388. Default value is 1.
  8389. @item stats_add_max
  8390. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  8391. Default value is 0.
  8392. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  8393. the filter will return an error.
  8394. @end table
  8395. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  8396. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  8397. couple of frames.
  8398. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  8399. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  8400. format with the following parameters:
  8401. @table @option
  8402. @item psnr_log_version
  8403. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  8404. @item fields
  8405. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  8406. the log.
  8407. @end table
  8408. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  8409. @table @option
  8410. @item n
  8411. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  8412. @item mse_avg
  8413. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  8414. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  8415. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_g, mse_a
  8416. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  8417. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  8418. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  8419. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  8420. specified by the suffix.
  8421. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  8422. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  8423. channels.
  8424. @end table
  8425. For example:
  8426. @example
  8427. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  8428. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  8429. @end example
  8430. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  8431. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  8432. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  8433. @anchor{pullup}
  8434. @section pullup
  8435. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  8436. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  8437. content.
  8438. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  8439. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  8440. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  8441. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  8442. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  8443. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  8444. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  8445. The filter accepts the following options:
  8446. @table @option
  8447. @item jl
  8448. @item jr
  8449. @item jt
  8450. @item jb
  8451. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  8452. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  8453. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  8454. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  8455. @item sb
  8456. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  8457. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  8458. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  8459. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  8460. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  8461. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  8462. Default value is @code{0}.
  8463. @item mp
  8464. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  8465. @table @samp
  8466. @item l
  8467. Use luma plane.
  8468. @item u
  8469. Use chroma blue plane.
  8470. @item v
  8471. Use chroma red plane.
  8472. @end table
  8473. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  8474. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  8475. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  8476. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  8477. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  8478. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  8479. @end table
  8480. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  8481. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  8482. telecine NTSC input:
  8483. @example
  8484. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  8485. @end example
  8486. @section qp
  8487. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  8488. The filter accepts the following option:
  8489. @table @option
  8490. @item qp
  8491. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  8492. @end table
  8493. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  8494. the following constants:
  8495. @table @var
  8496. @item known
  8497. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  8498. @item qp
  8499. Sequentional index starting from -129 to 128.
  8500. @end table
  8501. @subsection Examples
  8502. @itemize
  8503. @item
  8504. Some equation like:
  8505. @example
  8506. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  8507. @end example
  8508. @end itemize
  8509. @section random
  8510. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  8511. No frame is discarded.
  8512. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  8513. @table @option
  8514. @item frames
  8515. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  8516. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  8517. @item seed
  8518. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  8519. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  8520. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  8521. best effort basis.
  8522. @end table
  8523. @section readvitc
  8524. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  8525. video frame.
  8526. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  8527. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  8528. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  8529. timecode data has been found or not.
  8530. This filter accepts the following options:
  8531. @table @option
  8532. @item scan_max
  8533. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  8534. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  8535. @item thr_b
  8536. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  8537. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  8538. @item thr_w
  8539. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  8540. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  8541. @end table
  8542. @subsection Examples
  8543. @itemize
  8544. @item
  8545. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  8546. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  8547. @example
  8548. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  8549. @end example
  8550. @end itemize
  8551. @section remap
  8552. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  8553. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  8554. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  8555. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  8556. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  8557. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  8558. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  8559. @section removegrain
  8560. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  8561. @table @option
  8562. @item m0
  8563. Set mode for the first plane.
  8564. @item m1
  8565. Set mode for the second plane.
  8566. @item m2
  8567. Set mode for the third plane.
  8568. @item m3
  8569. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  8570. @end table
  8571. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  8572. @table @var
  8573. @item 0
  8574. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  8575. @item 1
  8576. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8577. @item 2
  8578. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8579. @item 3
  8580. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8581. @item 4
  8582. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  8583. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  8584. @item 5
  8585. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  8586. @item 6
  8587. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8588. @item 7
  8589. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8590. @item 8
  8591. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  8592. @item 9
  8593. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  8594. @item 10
  8595. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  8596. @item 11
  8597. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  8598. @item 12
  8599. Same as mode 11.
  8600. @item 13
  8601. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  8602. pixels are the closest.
  8603. @item 14
  8604. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  8605. pixels are the closest.
  8606. @item 15
  8607. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  8608. interpolation formula.
  8609. @item 16
  8610. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  8611. interpolation formula.
  8612. @item 17
  8613. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  8614. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  8615. @item 18
  8616. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  8617. the current pixel is minimal.
  8618. @item 19
  8619. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  8620. @item 20
  8621. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  8622. @item 21
  8623. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  8624. @item 22
  8625. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  8626. @item 23
  8627. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  8628. @item 24
  8629. Similar as 23.
  8630. @end table
  8631. @section removelogo
  8632. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  8633. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  8634. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  8635. The filter accepts the following options:
  8636. @table @option
  8637. @item filename, f
  8638. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  8639. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  8640. video stream being processed.
  8641. @end table
  8642. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  8643. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  8644. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  8645. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  8646. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  8647. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  8648. filter once or twice.
  8649. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  8650. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  8651. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  8652. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  8653. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  8654. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  8655. @section repeatfields
  8656. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  8657. fields based on its value.
  8658. @section reverse
  8659. Reverse a video clip.
  8660. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  8661. is suggested.
  8662. @subsection Examples
  8663. @itemize
  8664. @item
  8665. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  8666. @example
  8667. trim=end=5,reverse
  8668. @end example
  8669. @end itemize
  8670. @section rotate
  8671. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  8672. The filter accepts the following options:
  8673. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  8674. @table @option
  8675. @item angle, a
  8676. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  8677. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  8678. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  8679. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  8680. @item out_w, ow
  8681. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  8682. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  8683. @item out_h, oh
  8684. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  8685. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  8686. @item bilinear
  8687. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  8688. it. Default value is 1.
  8689. @item fillcolor, c
  8690. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  8691. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  8692. ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  8693. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  8694. Default value is "black".
  8695. @end table
  8696. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  8697. following constants and functions:
  8698. @table @option
  8699. @item n
  8700. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  8701. before the first frame is filtered.
  8702. @item t
  8703. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  8704. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  8705. @item hsub
  8706. @item vsub
  8707. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8708. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8709. @item in_w, iw
  8710. @item in_h, ih
  8711. the input video width and height
  8712. @item out_w, ow
  8713. @item out_h, oh
  8714. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  8715. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  8716. @item rotw(a)
  8717. @item roth(a)
  8718. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  8719. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  8720. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  8721. @option{out_h} expressions.
  8722. @end table
  8723. @subsection Examples
  8724. @itemize
  8725. @item
  8726. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  8727. @example
  8728. rotate=PI/6
  8729. @end example
  8730. @item
  8731. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  8732. @example
  8733. rotate=-PI/6
  8734. @end example
  8735. @item
  8736. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  8737. @example
  8738. rotate=45*PI/180
  8739. @end example
  8740. @item
  8741. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  8742. @example
  8743. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  8744. @end example
  8745. @item
  8746. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  8747. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  8748. @example
  8749. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  8750. @end example
  8751. @item
  8752. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  8753. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  8754. @example
  8755. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  8756. @end example
  8757. @item
  8758. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  8759. shown:
  8760. @example
  8761. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  8762. @end example
  8763. @end itemize
  8764. @subsection Commands
  8765. The filter supports the following commands:
  8766. @table @option
  8767. @item a, angle
  8768. Set the angle expression.
  8769. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8770. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8771. value.
  8772. @end table
  8773. @section sab
  8774. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  8775. The filter accepts the following options:
  8776. @table @option
  8777. @item luma_radius, lr
  8778. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  8779. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  8780. in slower processing.
  8781. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  8782. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  8783. value is 1.0.
  8784. @item luma_strength, ls
  8785. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  8786. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  8787. @item chroma_radius, cr
  8788. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  8789. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  8790. processing.
  8791. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  8792. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  8793. @item chroma_strength, cs
  8794. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  8795. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  8796. @end table
  8797. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  8798. corresponding luma option value.
  8799. @anchor{scale}
  8800. @section scale
  8801. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  8802. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  8803. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  8804. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  8805. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  8806. requested format.
  8807. @subsection Options
  8808. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  8809. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  8810. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  8811. the complete list of scaler options.
  8812. @table @option
  8813. @item width, w
  8814. @item height, h
  8815. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  8816. dimension.
  8817. If the value is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  8818. If one of the values is -1, the scale filter will use a value that
  8819. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  8820. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  8821. used
  8822. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the scale filter will also use a value
  8823. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  8824. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  8825. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  8826. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  8827. expression.
  8828. @item eval
  8829. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  8830. @table @samp
  8831. @item init
  8832. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  8833. @item frame
  8834. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8835. @end table
  8836. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8837. @item interl
  8838. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  8839. @table @samp
  8840. @item 1
  8841. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  8842. @item 0
  8843. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  8844. @item -1
  8845. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  8846. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  8847. @end table
  8848. Default value is @samp{0}.
  8849. @item flags
  8850. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  8851. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8852. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8853. the default flags.
  8854. @item param0, param1
  8855. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  8856. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  8857. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  8858. empty parameters.
  8859. @item size, s
  8860. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  8861. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  8862. @item in_color_matrix
  8863. @item out_color_matrix
  8864. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  8865. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8866. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  8867. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  8868. Possible values:
  8869. @table @samp
  8870. @item auto
  8871. Choose automatically.
  8872. @item bt709
  8873. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  8874. Recommendation BT.709.
  8875. @item fcc
  8876. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  8877. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  8878. @item bt601
  8879. Set color space conforming to:
  8880. @itemize
  8881. @item
  8882. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  8883. @item
  8884. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  8885. @item
  8886. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  8887. @end itemize
  8888. @item smpte240m
  8889. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  8890. @end table
  8891. @item in_range
  8892. @item out_range
  8893. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  8894. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  8895. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  8896. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  8897. @table @samp
  8898. @item auto
  8899. Choose automatically.
  8900. @item jpeg/full/pc
  8901. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8902. @item mpeg/tv
  8903. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  8904. @end table
  8905. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  8906. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  8907. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  8908. @table @samp
  8909. @item disable
  8910. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  8911. @item decrease
  8912. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  8913. @item increase
  8914. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  8915. @end table
  8916. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  8917. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  8918. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  8919. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  8920. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  8921. 1280x533.
  8922. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  8923. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  8924. to work.
  8925. @end table
  8926. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  8927. containing the following constants:
  8928. @table @var
  8929. @item in_w
  8930. @item in_h
  8931. The input width and height
  8932. @item iw
  8933. @item ih
  8934. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  8935. @item out_w
  8936. @item out_h
  8937. The output (scaled) width and height
  8938. @item ow
  8939. @item oh
  8940. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  8941. @item a
  8942. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  8943. @item sar
  8944. input sample aspect ratio
  8945. @item dar
  8946. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  8947. @item hsub
  8948. @item vsub
  8949. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8950. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8951. @item ohsub
  8952. @item ovsub
  8953. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  8954. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  8955. @end table
  8956. @subsection Examples
  8957. @itemize
  8958. @item
  8959. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  8960. @example
  8961. scale=w=200:h=100
  8962. @end example
  8963. This is equivalent to:
  8964. @example
  8965. scale=200:100
  8966. @end example
  8967. or:
  8968. @example
  8969. scale=200x100
  8970. @end example
  8971. @item
  8972. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  8973. @example
  8974. scale=qcif
  8975. @end example
  8976. which can also be written as:
  8977. @example
  8978. scale=size=qcif
  8979. @end example
  8980. @item
  8981. Scale the input to 2x:
  8982. @example
  8983. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  8984. @end example
  8985. @item
  8986. The above is the same as:
  8987. @example
  8988. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  8989. @end example
  8990. @item
  8991. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  8992. @example
  8993. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  8994. @end example
  8995. @item
  8996. Scale the input to half size:
  8997. @example
  8998. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  8999. @end example
  9000. @item
  9001. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  9002. @example
  9003. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  9004. @end example
  9005. @item
  9006. Seek Greek harmony:
  9007. @example
  9008. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  9009. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  9010. @end example
  9011. @item
  9012. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  9013. @example
  9014. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  9015. @end example
  9016. @item
  9017. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  9018. subsample values:
  9019. @example
  9020. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  9021. @end example
  9022. @item
  9023. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  9024. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  9025. @example
  9026. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  9027. @end example
  9028. @end itemize
  9029. @subsection Commands
  9030. This filter supports the following commands:
  9031. @table @option
  9032. @item width, w
  9033. @item height, h
  9034. Set the output video dimension expression.
  9035. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9036. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9037. value.
  9038. @end table
  9039. @section scale_npp
  9040. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  9041. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  9042. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  9043. The following additional options are accepted:
  9044. @table @option
  9045. @item format
  9046. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  9047. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  9048. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  9049. @item interp_algo
  9050. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  9051. @table @option
  9052. @item nn
  9053. Nearest neighbour.
  9054. @item linear
  9055. @item cubic
  9056. @item cubic2p_bspline
  9057. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  9058. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  9059. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  9060. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  9061. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  9062. @item super
  9063. Supersampling
  9064. @item lanczos
  9065. @end table
  9066. @end table
  9067. @section scale2ref
  9068. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  9069. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  9070. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis.
  9071. @subsection Examples
  9072. @itemize
  9073. @item
  9074. Scale a subtitle stream to match the main video in size before overlaying
  9075. @example
  9076. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  9077. @end example
  9078. @end itemize
  9079. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  9080. @section selectivecolor
  9081. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  9082. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  9083. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  9084. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  9085. The filter accepts the following options:
  9086. @table @option
  9087. @item correction_method
  9088. Select color correction method.
  9089. Available values are:
  9090. @table @samp
  9091. @item absolute
  9092. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  9093. component value).
  9094. @item relative
  9095. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  9096. @end table
  9097. Default is @code{absolute}.
  9098. @item reds
  9099. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  9100. @item yellows
  9101. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  9102. @item greens
  9103. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  9104. @item cyans
  9105. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  9106. @item blues
  9107. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  9108. @item magentas
  9109. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  9110. @item whites
  9111. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  9112. @item neutrals
  9113. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  9114. @item blacks
  9115. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  9116. @item psfile
  9117. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  9118. @end table
  9119. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  9120. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  9121. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  9122. pixels of its range.
  9123. @subsection Examples
  9124. @itemize
  9125. @item
  9126. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  9127. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  9128. @example
  9129. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  9130. @end example
  9131. @item
  9132. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  9133. @example
  9134. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  9135. @end example
  9136. @end itemize
  9137. @anchor{separatefields}
  9138. @section separatefields
  9139. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  9140. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  9141. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  9142. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  9143. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  9144. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  9145. @section setdar, setsar
  9146. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  9147. output video.
  9148. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  9149. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  9150. @example
  9151. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  9152. @end example
  9153. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  9154. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  9155. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  9156. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  9157. applied.
  9158. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  9159. the filter output video.
  9160. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  9161. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  9162. above.
  9163. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  9164. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  9165. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  9166. It accepts the following parameters:
  9167. @table @option
  9168. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  9169. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  9170. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  9171. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  9172. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  9173. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  9174. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  9175. should be escaped.
  9176. @item max
  9177. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  9178. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  9179. Default value is @code{100}.
  9180. @end table
  9181. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  9182. the following constants:
  9183. @table @option
  9184. @item E, PI, PHI
  9185. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  9186. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  9187. @item w, h
  9188. The input width and height.
  9189. @item a
  9190. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  9191. @item sar
  9192. The input sample aspect ratio.
  9193. @item dar
  9194. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  9195. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  9196. @item hsub, vsub
  9197. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  9198. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  9199. @end table
  9200. @subsection Examples
  9201. @itemize
  9202. @item
  9203. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  9204. @example
  9205. setdar=dar=1.77777
  9206. setdar=dar=16/9
  9207. @end example
  9208. @item
  9209. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  9210. @example
  9211. setsar=sar=10/11
  9212. @end example
  9213. @item
  9214. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  9215. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  9216. @example
  9217. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  9218. @end example
  9219. @end itemize
  9220. @anchor{setfield}
  9221. @section setfield
  9222. Force field for the output video frame.
  9223. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  9224. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  9225. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  9226. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  9227. The filter accepts the following options:
  9228. @table @option
  9229. @item mode
  9230. Available values are:
  9231. @table @samp
  9232. @item auto
  9233. Keep the same field property.
  9234. @item bff
  9235. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  9236. @item tff
  9237. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  9238. @item prog
  9239. Mark the frame as progressive.
  9240. @end table
  9241. @end table
  9242. @section showinfo
  9243. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  9244. The input video is not modified.
  9245. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  9246. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  9247. The following values are shown in the output:
  9248. @table @option
  9249. @item n
  9250. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  9251. @item pts
  9252. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  9253. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  9254. @item pts_time
  9255. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  9256. seconds.
  9257. @item pos
  9258. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  9259. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  9260. @item fmt
  9261. The pixel format name.
  9262. @item sar
  9263. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  9264. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  9265. @item s
  9266. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9267. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9268. @item i
  9269. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  9270. for bottom field first).
  9271. @item iskey
  9272. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  9273. @item type
  9274. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  9275. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  9276. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  9277. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  9278. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  9279. @item checksum
  9280. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  9281. @item plane_checksum
  9282. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  9283. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  9284. @end table
  9285. @section showpalette
  9286. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  9287. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  9288. It accepts the following option:
  9289. @table @option
  9290. @item s
  9291. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  9292. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  9293. @end table
  9294. @section shuffleframes
  9295. Reorder and/or duplicate video frames.
  9296. It accepts the following parameters:
  9297. @table @option
  9298. @item mapping
  9299. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  9300. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  9301. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  9302. @end table
  9303. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  9304. @subsection Examples
  9305. @itemize
  9306. @item
  9307. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  9308. @example
  9309. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  9310. @end example
  9311. @item
  9312. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  9313. @example
  9314. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  9315. @end example
  9316. @end itemize
  9317. @section shuffleplanes
  9318. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  9319. It accepts the following parameters:
  9320. @table @option
  9321. @item map0
  9322. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  9323. @item map1
  9324. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  9325. @item map2
  9326. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  9327. @item map3
  9328. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  9329. @end table
  9330. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  9331. @subsection Examples
  9332. @itemize
  9333. @item
  9334. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  9335. @example
  9336. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  9337. @end example
  9338. @end itemize
  9339. @anchor{signalstats}
  9340. @section signalstats
  9341. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  9342. with the digitization of analog video media.
  9343. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  9344. @table @option
  9345. @item YMIN
  9346. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9347. range of [0-255].
  9348. @item YLOW
  9349. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9350. range of [0-255].
  9351. @item YAVG
  9352. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9353. [0-255].
  9354. @item YHIGH
  9355. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9356. range of [0-255].
  9357. @item YMAX
  9358. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9359. range of [0-255].
  9360. @item UMIN
  9361. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9362. range of [0-255].
  9363. @item ULOW
  9364. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9365. range of [0-255].
  9366. @item UAVG
  9367. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9368. [0-255].
  9369. @item UHIGH
  9370. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9371. range of [0-255].
  9372. @item UMAX
  9373. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9374. range of [0-255].
  9375. @item VMIN
  9376. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9377. range of [0-255].
  9378. @item VLOW
  9379. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9380. range of [0-255].
  9381. @item VAVG
  9382. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9383. [0-255].
  9384. @item VHIGH
  9385. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  9386. range of [0-255].
  9387. @item VMAX
  9388. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  9389. range of [0-255].
  9390. @item SATMIN
  9391. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  9392. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9393. @item SATLOW
  9394. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  9395. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9396. @item SATAVG
  9397. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  9398. of [0-~181.02].
  9399. @item SATHIGH
  9400. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  9401. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9402. @item SATMAX
  9403. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  9404. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  9405. @item HUEMED
  9406. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9407. [0-360].
  9408. @item HUEAVG
  9409. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  9410. [0-360].
  9411. @item YDIF
  9412. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  9413. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9414. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9415. @item UDIF
  9416. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  9417. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9418. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9419. @item VDIF
  9420. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  9421. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  9422. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  9423. @item YBITDEPTH
  9424. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  9425. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9426. @item UBITDEPTH
  9427. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  9428. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9429. @item VBITDEPTH
  9430. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  9431. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  9432. @end table
  9433. The filter accepts the following options:
  9434. @table @option
  9435. @item stat
  9436. @item out
  9437. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  9438. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  9439. Both options accept the following values:
  9440. @table @samp
  9441. @item tout
  9442. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  9443. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  9444. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  9445. @item vrep
  9446. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  9447. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  9448. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  9449. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  9450. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  9451. @item brng
  9452. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  9453. @end table
  9454. @item color, c
  9455. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  9456. yellow.
  9457. @end table
  9458. @subsection Examples
  9459. @itemize
  9460. @item
  9461. Output data of various video metrics:
  9462. @example
  9463. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  9464. @end example
  9465. @item
  9466. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  9467. @example
  9468. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  9469. @end example
  9470. @item
  9471. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  9472. @example
  9473. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  9474. @end example
  9475. @item
  9476. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  9477. @example
  9478. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  9479. @end example
  9480. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  9481. @example
  9482. time %@{pts:hms@}
  9483. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  9484. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  9485. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  9486. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  9487. @end example
  9488. @end itemize
  9489. @anchor{smartblur}
  9490. @section smartblur
  9491. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  9492. It accepts the following options:
  9493. @table @option
  9494. @item luma_radius, lr
  9495. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  9496. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  9497. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  9498. @item luma_strength, ls
  9499. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  9500. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  9501. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  9502. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  9503. @item luma_threshold, lt
  9504. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  9505. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  9506. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  9507. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  9508. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  9509. @item chroma_radius, cr
  9510. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  9511. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  9512. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  9513. @item chroma_strength, cs
  9514. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  9515. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  9516. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  9517. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  9518. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  9519. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  9520. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  9521. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  9522. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  9523. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  9524. @end table
  9525. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  9526. is set.
  9527. @section ssim
  9528. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  9529. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  9530. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  9531. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  9532. the SSIM.
  9533. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  9534. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  9535. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  9536. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  9537. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9538. @table @option
  9539. @item stats_file, f
  9540. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  9541. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  9542. standard output.
  9543. @end table
  9544. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  9545. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  9546. couple of frames.
  9547. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  9548. @table @option
  9549. @item n
  9550. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  9551. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  9552. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  9553. @item All
  9554. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  9555. @item dB
  9556. Same as above but in dB representation.
  9557. @end table
  9558. For example:
  9559. @example
  9560. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  9561. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  9562. @end example
  9563. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  9564. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  9565. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  9566. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  9567. @example
  9568. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  9569. @end example
  9570. @section stereo3d
  9571. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  9572. The filters accept the following options:
  9573. @table @option
  9574. @item in
  9575. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  9576. Available values for input image formats are:
  9577. @table @samp
  9578. @item sbsl
  9579. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  9580. @item sbsr
  9581. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  9582. @item sbs2l
  9583. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  9584. (left eye left, right eye right)
  9585. @item sbs2r
  9586. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  9587. (right eye left, left eye right)
  9588. @item abl
  9589. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  9590. @item abr
  9591. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  9592. @item ab2l
  9593. above-below with half height resolution
  9594. (left eye above, right eye below)
  9595. @item ab2r
  9596. above-below with half height resolution
  9597. (right eye above, left eye below)
  9598. @item al
  9599. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  9600. @item ar
  9601. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  9602. @item irl
  9603. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  9604. @item irr
  9605. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  9606. @item icl
  9607. interleaved columns, left eye first
  9608. @item icr
  9609. interleaved columns, right eye first
  9610. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  9611. @end table
  9612. @item out
  9613. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  9614. @table @samp
  9615. @item sbsl
  9616. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  9617. @item sbsr
  9618. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  9619. @item sbs2l
  9620. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  9621. (left eye left, right eye right)
  9622. @item sbs2r
  9623. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  9624. (right eye left, left eye right)
  9625. @item abl
  9626. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  9627. @item abr
  9628. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  9629. @item ab2l
  9630. above-below with half height resolution
  9631. (left eye above, right eye below)
  9632. @item ab2r
  9633. above-below with half height resolution
  9634. (right eye above, left eye below)
  9635. @item al
  9636. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  9637. @item ar
  9638. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  9639. @item irl
  9640. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  9641. @item irr
  9642. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  9643. @item arbg
  9644. anaglyph red/blue gray
  9645. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9646. @item argg
  9647. anaglyph red/green gray
  9648. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  9649. @item arcg
  9650. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  9651. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9652. @item arch
  9653. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  9654. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9655. @item arcc
  9656. anaglyph red/cyan color
  9657. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9658. @item arcd
  9659. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9660. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  9661. @item agmg
  9662. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  9663. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9664. @item agmh
  9665. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  9666. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9667. @item agmc
  9668. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  9669. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9670. @item agmd
  9671. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9672. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  9673. @item aybg
  9674. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  9675. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9676. @item aybh
  9677. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  9678. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9679. @item aybc
  9680. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  9681. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9682. @item aybd
  9683. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  9684. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  9685. @item ml
  9686. mono output (left eye only)
  9687. @item mr
  9688. mono output (right eye only)
  9689. @item chl
  9690. checkerboard, left eye first
  9691. @item chr
  9692. checkerboard, right eye first
  9693. @item icl
  9694. interleaved columns, left eye first
  9695. @item icr
  9696. interleaved columns, right eye first
  9697. @item hdmi
  9698. HDMI frame pack
  9699. @end table
  9700. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  9701. @end table
  9702. @subsection Examples
  9703. @itemize
  9704. @item
  9705. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  9706. @example
  9707. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  9708. @end example
  9709. @item
  9710. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  9711. @example
  9712. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  9713. @end example
  9714. @end itemize
  9715. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  9716. Select video or audio streams.
  9717. The filter accepts the following options:
  9718. @table @option
  9719. @item inputs
  9720. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  9721. @item map
  9722. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  9723. @end table
  9724. @subsection Commands
  9725. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  9726. commands:
  9727. @table @option
  9728. @item map
  9729. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  9730. @end table
  9731. @subsection Examples
  9732. @itemize
  9733. @item
  9734. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  9735. @example
  9736. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  9737. @end example
  9738. @item
  9739. Same as above, but for audio:
  9740. @example
  9741. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  9742. @end example
  9743. @end itemize
  9744. @anchor{spp}
  9745. @section spp
  9746. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  9747. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  9748. and average the results.
  9749. The filter accepts the following options:
  9750. @table @option
  9751. @item quality
  9752. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  9753. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  9754. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  9755. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  9756. @code{3}.
  9757. @item qp
  9758. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  9759. from the video stream (if available).
  9760. @item mode
  9761. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  9762. @table @samp
  9763. @item hard
  9764. Set hard thresholding (default).
  9765. @item soft
  9766. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  9767. @end table
  9768. @item use_bframe_qp
  9769. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  9770. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  9771. @code{0} (not enabled).
  9772. @end table
  9773. @anchor{subtitles}
  9774. @section subtitles
  9775. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  9776. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  9777. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  9778. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  9779. Alpha) subtitles format.
  9780. The filter accepts the following options:
  9781. @table @option
  9782. @item filename, f
  9783. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  9784. @item original_size
  9785. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  9786. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9787. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9788. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  9789. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  9790. @item fontsdir
  9791. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  9792. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  9793. @item charenc
  9794. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  9795. useful if not UTF-8.
  9796. @item stream_index, si
  9797. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  9798. @item force_style
  9799. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  9800. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  9801. @end table
  9802. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  9803. specifies the @option{filename}.
  9804. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  9805. video, use the command:
  9806. @example
  9807. subtitles=sub.srt
  9808. @end example
  9809. which is equivalent to:
  9810. @example
  9811. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  9812. @end example
  9813. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  9814. @example
  9815. subtitles=video.mkv
  9816. @end example
  9817. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  9818. @example
  9819. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  9820. @end example
  9821. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in transparent green
  9822. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  9823. @example
  9824. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HAA00FF00'
  9825. @end example
  9826. @section super2xsai
  9827. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  9828. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  9829. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  9830. @section swaprect
  9831. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  9832. This filter accepts the following options:
  9833. @table @option
  9834. @item w
  9835. Set object width.
  9836. @item h
  9837. Set object height.
  9838. @item x1
  9839. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  9840. @item y1
  9841. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  9842. @item x2
  9843. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  9844. @item y2
  9845. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  9846. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  9847. @end table
  9848. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  9849. @table @option
  9850. @item w
  9851. @item h
  9852. The input width and height.
  9853. @item a
  9854. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  9855. @item sar
  9856. input sample aspect ratio
  9857. @item dar
  9858. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  9859. @item n
  9860. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  9861. @item t
  9862. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  9863. @item pos
  9864. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  9865. @end table
  9866. @section swapuv
  9867. Swap U & V plane.
  9868. @section telecine
  9869. Apply telecine process to the video.
  9870. This filter accepts the following options:
  9871. @table @option
  9872. @item first_field
  9873. @table @samp
  9874. @item top, t
  9875. top field first
  9876. @item bottom, b
  9877. bottom field first
  9878. The default value is @code{top}.
  9879. @end table
  9880. @item pattern
  9881. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  9882. The default value is @code{23}.
  9883. @end table
  9884. @example
  9885. Some typical patterns:
  9886. NTSC output (30i):
  9887. 27.5p: 32222
  9888. 24p: 23 (classic)
  9889. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  9890. 20p: 33
  9891. 18p: 334
  9892. 16p: 3444
  9893. PAL output (25i):
  9894. 27.5p: 12222
  9895. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  9896. 16.67p: 33
  9897. 16p: 33333334
  9898. @end example
  9899. @section thumbnail
  9900. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  9901. The filter accepts the following options:
  9902. @table @option
  9903. @item n
  9904. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  9905. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  9906. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  9907. @end table
  9908. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  9909. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  9910. @subsection Examples
  9911. @itemize
  9912. @item
  9913. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  9914. @example
  9915. thumbnail=50
  9916. @end example
  9917. @item
  9918. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9919. @example
  9920. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  9921. @end example
  9922. @end itemize
  9923. @section tile
  9924. Tile several successive frames together.
  9925. The filter accepts the following options:
  9926. @table @option
  9927. @item layout
  9928. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  9929. this option, check the
  9930. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  9931. @item nb_frames
  9932. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  9933. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  9934. the area will be used.
  9935. @item margin
  9936. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  9937. @item padding
  9938. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  9939. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  9940. refer to the pad video filter.
  9941. @item color
  9942. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  9943. "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. The default value of @var{color}
  9944. is "black".
  9945. @end table
  9946. @subsection Examples
  9947. @itemize
  9948. @item
  9949. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  9950. @example
  9951. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  9952. @end example
  9953. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  9954. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  9955. rate.
  9956. @item
  9957. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  9958. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  9959. mixed flat and named options:
  9960. @example
  9961. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  9962. @end example
  9963. @end itemize
  9964. @section tinterlace
  9965. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  9966. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  9967. considered odd.
  9968. The filter accepts the following options:
  9969. @table @option
  9970. @item mode
  9971. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  9972. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  9973. Available values are:
  9974. @table @samp
  9975. @item merge, 0
  9976. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  9977. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  9978. @example
  9979. ------> time
  9980. Input:
  9981. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  9982. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9983. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9984. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9985. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  9986. Output:
  9987. 11111 33333
  9988. 22222 44444
  9989. 11111 33333
  9990. 22222 44444
  9991. 11111 33333
  9992. 22222 44444
  9993. 11111 33333
  9994. 22222 44444
  9995. @end example
  9996. @item drop_even, 1
  9997. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  9998. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  9999. @example
  10000. ------> time
  10001. Input:
  10002. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10003. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10004. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10005. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10006. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10007. Output:
  10008. 11111 33333
  10009. 11111 33333
  10010. 11111 33333
  10011. 11111 33333
  10012. @end example
  10013. @item drop_odd, 2
  10014. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  10015. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10016. @example
  10017. ------> time
  10018. Input:
  10019. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10020. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10021. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10022. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10023. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10024. Output:
  10025. 22222 44444
  10026. 22222 44444
  10027. 22222 44444
  10028. 22222 44444
  10029. @end example
  10030. @item pad, 3
  10031. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  10032. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  10033. @example
  10034. ------> time
  10035. Input:
  10036. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10037. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10038. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10039. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10040. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10041. Output:
  10042. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10043. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10044. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10045. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10046. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10047. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10048. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  10049. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  10050. @end example
  10051. @item interleave_top, 4
  10052. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  10053. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10054. @example
  10055. ------> time
  10056. Input:
  10057. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10058. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10059. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10060. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10061. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10062. Output:
  10063. 11111 33333
  10064. 22222 44444
  10065. 11111 33333
  10066. 22222 44444
  10067. @end example
  10068. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  10069. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  10070. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  10071. @example
  10072. ------> time
  10073. Input:
  10074. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10075. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10076. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10077. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  10078. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  10079. Output:
  10080. 22222 44444
  10081. 11111 33333
  10082. 22222 44444
  10083. 11111 33333
  10084. @end example
  10085. @item interlacex2, 6
  10086. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  10087. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  10088. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  10089. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  10090. field synchronisation.
  10091. @example
  10092. ------> time
  10093. Input:
  10094. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10095. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10096. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10097. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10098. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10099. Output:
  10100. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  10101. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  10102. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  10103. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  10104. @end example
  10105. @item mergex2, 7
  10106. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  10107. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  10108. @example
  10109. ------> time
  10110. Input:
  10111. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  10112. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10113. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10114. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10115. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  10116. Output:
  10117. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10118. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10119. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10120. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10121. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10122. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10123. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  10124. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  10125. @end example
  10126. @end table
  10127. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  10128. compatibility reasons.
  10129. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  10130. @item flags
  10131. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  10132. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  10133. @table @option
  10134. @item low_pass_filter, vlfp
  10135. Enable vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  10136. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  10137. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  10138. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  10139. patterning.
  10140. Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
  10141. @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  10142. @end table
  10143. @end table
  10144. @section transpose
  10145. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  10146. It accepts the following parameters:
  10147. @table @option
  10148. @item dir
  10149. Specify the transposition direction.
  10150. Can assume the following values:
  10151. @table @samp
  10152. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  10153. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  10154. @example
  10155. L.R L.l
  10156. . . -> . .
  10157. l.r R.r
  10158. @end example
  10159. @item 1, 5, clock
  10160. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  10161. @example
  10162. L.R l.L
  10163. . . -> . .
  10164. l.r r.R
  10165. @end example
  10166. @item 2, 6, cclock
  10167. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  10168. @example
  10169. L.R R.r
  10170. . . -> . .
  10171. l.r L.l
  10172. @end example
  10173. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  10174. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  10175. @example
  10176. L.R r.R
  10177. . . -> . .
  10178. l.r l.L
  10179. @end example
  10180. @end table
  10181. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  10182. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  10183. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  10184. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  10185. symbolic constants.
  10186. @item passthrough
  10187. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  10188. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  10189. @table @samp
  10190. @item none
  10191. Always apply transposition.
  10192. @item portrait
  10193. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  10194. @item landscape
  10195. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  10196. @end table
  10197. Default value is @code{none}.
  10198. @end table
  10199. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  10200. layout:
  10201. @example
  10202. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  10203. @end example
  10204. The command above can also be specified as:
  10205. @example
  10206. transpose=1:portrait
  10207. @end example
  10208. @section trim
  10209. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  10210. It accepts the following parameters:
  10211. @table @option
  10212. @item start
  10213. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  10214. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  10215. @item end
  10216. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  10217. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  10218. frame in the output.
  10219. @item start_pts
  10220. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  10221. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  10222. @item end_pts
  10223. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  10224. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  10225. @item duration
  10226. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  10227. @item start_frame
  10228. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  10229. @item end_frame
  10230. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  10231. @end table
  10232. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  10233. duration specifications; see
  10234. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  10235. for the accepted syntax.
  10236. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  10237. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  10238. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  10239. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  10240. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  10241. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  10242. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  10243. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  10244. filters.
  10245. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  10246. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  10247. Examples:
  10248. @itemize
  10249. @item
  10250. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  10251. @example
  10252. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  10253. @end example
  10254. @item
  10255. Keep only the first second:
  10256. @example
  10257. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  10258. @end example
  10259. @end itemize
  10260. @anchor{unsharp}
  10261. @section unsharp
  10262. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  10263. It accepts the following parameters:
  10264. @table @option
  10265. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  10266. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  10267. 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  10268. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  10269. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  10270. and 63. The default value is 5.
  10271. @item luma_amount, la
  10272. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  10273. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  10274. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  10275. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  10276. Default value is 1.0.
  10277. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  10278. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  10279. between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  10280. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  10281. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  10282. between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
  10283. @item chroma_amount, ca
  10284. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  10285. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  10286. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  10287. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  10288. Default value is 0.0.
  10289. @item opencl
  10290. If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
  10291. FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
  10292. @end table
  10293. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  10294. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  10295. @subsection Examples
  10296. @itemize
  10297. @item
  10298. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  10299. @example
  10300. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  10301. @end example
  10302. @item
  10303. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  10304. @example
  10305. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  10306. @end example
  10307. @end itemize
  10308. @section uspp
  10309. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  10310. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  10311. shifts and average the results.
  10312. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  10313. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  10314. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  10315. The filter accepts the following options:
  10316. @table @option
  10317. @item quality
  10318. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  10319. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  10320. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  10321. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  10322. @code{3}.
  10323. @item qp
  10324. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  10325. from the video stream (if available).
  10326. @end table
  10327. @section vaguedenoiser
  10328. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  10329. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  10330. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  10331. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  10332. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  10333. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  10334. This filter accepts the following options:
  10335. @table @option
  10336. @item threshold
  10337. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  10338. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  10339. before the video looks overfiltered.
  10340. @item method
  10341. The filtering method the filter will use.
  10342. It accepts the following values:
  10343. @table @samp
  10344. @item hard
  10345. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  10346. @item soft
  10347. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  10348. reduced by the threshold.
  10349. @item garrote
  10350. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  10351. (less) hard thresholding.
  10352. @end table
  10353. @item nsteps
  10354. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  10355. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  10356. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480)
  10357. @item percent
  10358. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100.
  10359. @item planes
  10360. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  10361. @end table
  10362. @section vectorscope
  10363. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  10364. a vectorscope).
  10365. This filter accepts the following options:
  10366. @table @option
  10367. @item mode, m
  10368. Set vectorscope mode.
  10369. It accepts the following values:
  10370. @table @samp
  10371. @item gray
  10372. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  10373. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  10374. @item color
  10375. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  10376. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  10377. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  10378. @item color2
  10379. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  10380. @item color3
  10381. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  10382. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  10383. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  10384. @item color4
  10385. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  10386. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  10387. not present in graph is picked.
  10388. @item color5
  10389. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  10390. component picked from radial gradient.
  10391. @end table
  10392. @item x
  10393. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  10394. @item y
  10395. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  10396. @item intensity, i
  10397. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  10398. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  10399. @item envelope, e
  10400. @table @samp
  10401. @item none
  10402. No envelope, this is default.
  10403. @item instant
  10404. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  10405. @item peak
  10406. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  10407. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  10408. @item peak+instant
  10409. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  10410. @end table
  10411. @item graticule, g
  10412. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  10413. @table @samp
  10414. @item none
  10415. @item green
  10416. @item color
  10417. @end table
  10418. @item opacity, o
  10419. Set graticule opacity.
  10420. @item flags, f
  10421. Set graticule flags.
  10422. @table @samp
  10423. @item white
  10424. Draw graticule for white point.
  10425. @item black
  10426. Draw graticule for black point.
  10427. @item name
  10428. Draw color points short names.
  10429. @end table
  10430. @item bgopacity, b
  10431. Set background opacity.
  10432. @item lthreshold, l
  10433. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  10434. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  10435. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  10436. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  10437. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  10438. @item hthreshold, h
  10439. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  10440. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  10441. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  10442. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  10443. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  10444. @item colorspace, c
  10445. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  10446. @table @samp
  10447. @item auto
  10448. @item 601
  10449. @item 709
  10450. @end table
  10451. Default is auto.
  10452. @end table
  10453. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  10454. @section vidstabdetect
  10455. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  10456. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  10457. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  10458. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  10459. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  10460. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10461. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  10462. This filter accepts the following options:
  10463. @table @option
  10464. @item result
  10465. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  10466. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  10467. @item shakiness
  10468. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  10469. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  10470. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  10471. @item accuracy
  10472. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  10473. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  10474. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  10475. @item stepsize
  10476. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  10477. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  10478. @item mincontrast
  10479. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  10480. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  10481. value is 0.3.
  10482. @item tripod
  10483. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  10484. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  10485. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  10486. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  10487. the camera view absolutely still.
  10488. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  10489. @item show
  10490. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  10491. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  10492. visualization.
  10493. @end table
  10494. @subsection Examples
  10495. @itemize
  10496. @item
  10497. Use default values:
  10498. @example
  10499. vidstabdetect
  10500. @end example
  10501. @item
  10502. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  10503. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  10504. @example
  10505. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  10506. @end example
  10507. @item
  10508. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  10509. video:
  10510. @example
  10511. vidstabdetect=show=1
  10512. @end example
  10513. @item
  10514. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  10515. @example
  10516. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  10517. @end example
  10518. @end itemize
  10519. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  10520. @section vidstabtransform
  10521. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  10522. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  10523. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  10524. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  10525. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  10526. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  10527. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  10528. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10529. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  10530. @subsection Options
  10531. @table @option
  10532. @item input
  10533. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  10534. @file{transforms.trf}.
  10535. @item smoothing
  10536. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  10537. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  10538. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  10539. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  10540. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  10541. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  10542. camera is simulated.
  10543. @item optalgo
  10544. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  10545. Accepted values are:
  10546. @table @samp
  10547. @item gauss
  10548. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  10549. @item avg
  10550. averaging on transformations
  10551. @end table
  10552. @item maxshift
  10553. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  10554. meaning no limit.
  10555. @item maxangle
  10556. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  10557. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  10558. @item crop
  10559. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  10560. compensation.
  10561. Available values are:
  10562. @table @samp
  10563. @item keep
  10564. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  10565. @item black
  10566. fill the border black
  10567. @end table
  10568. @item invert
  10569. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  10570. @item relative
  10571. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  10572. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  10573. @item zoom
  10574. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  10575. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  10576. zoom).
  10577. @item optzoom
  10578. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  10579. Accepted values are:
  10580. @table @samp
  10581. @item 0
  10582. disabled
  10583. @item 1
  10584. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  10585. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  10586. @item 2
  10587. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  10588. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  10589. @end table
  10590. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  10591. @item zoomspeed
  10592. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  10593. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  10594. 0.25.
  10595. @item interpol
  10596. Specify type of interpolation.
  10597. Available values are:
  10598. @table @samp
  10599. @item no
  10600. no interpolation
  10601. @item linear
  10602. linear only horizontal
  10603. @item bilinear
  10604. linear in both directions (default)
  10605. @item bicubic
  10606. cubic in both directions (slow)
  10607. @end table
  10608. @item tripod
  10609. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  10610. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  10611. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  10612. @item debug
  10613. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  10614. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  10615. value is 0.
  10616. @end table
  10617. @subsection Examples
  10618. @itemize
  10619. @item
  10620. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  10621. @example
  10622. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  10623. @end example
  10624. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  10625. @item
  10626. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  10627. @example
  10628. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  10629. @end example
  10630. @item
  10631. Smoothen the video even more:
  10632. @example
  10633. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  10634. @end example
  10635. @end itemize
  10636. @section vflip
  10637. Flip the input video vertically.
  10638. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  10639. @example
  10640. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  10641. @end example
  10642. @anchor{vignette}
  10643. @section vignette
  10644. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  10645. The filter accepts the following options:
  10646. @table @option
  10647. @item angle, a
  10648. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  10649. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  10650. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  10651. @item x0
  10652. @item y0
  10653. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  10654. by default.
  10655. @item mode
  10656. Set forward/backward mode.
  10657. Available modes are:
  10658. @table @samp
  10659. @item forward
  10660. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  10661. @item backward
  10662. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  10663. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  10664. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  10665. also be used to create a burning effect.
  10666. @end table
  10667. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  10668. @item eval
  10669. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  10670. It accepts the following values:
  10671. @table @samp
  10672. @item init
  10673. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  10674. @item frame
  10675. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  10676. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  10677. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  10678. @end table
  10679. Default value is @samp{init}.
  10680. @item dither
  10681. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  10682. (enabled).
  10683. @item aspect
  10684. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  10685. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  10686. following the dimensions of the video.
  10687. Default is @code{1/1}.
  10688. @end table
  10689. @subsection Expressions
  10690. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  10691. following parameters.
  10692. @table @option
  10693. @item w
  10694. @item h
  10695. input width and height
  10696. @item n
  10697. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10698. @item pts
  10699. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  10700. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  10701. @item r
  10702. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  10703. @item t
  10704. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  10705. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  10706. @item tb
  10707. time base of the input video
  10708. @end table
  10709. @subsection Examples
  10710. @itemize
  10711. @item
  10712. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  10713. @example
  10714. vignette=PI/4
  10715. @end example
  10716. @item
  10717. Make a flickering vignetting:
  10718. @example
  10719. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  10720. @end example
  10721. @end itemize
  10722. @section vstack
  10723. Stack input videos vertically.
  10724. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  10725. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  10726. to create same output.
  10727. The filter accept the following option:
  10728. @table @option
  10729. @item inputs
  10730. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  10731. @item shortest
  10732. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  10733. terminates. Default value is 0.
  10734. @end table
  10735. @section w3fdif
  10736. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  10737. Deinterlacing Filter").
  10738. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  10739. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  10740. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  10741. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  10742. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple":
  10743. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  10744. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  10745. @table @option
  10746. @item filter
  10747. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  10748. @table @samp
  10749. @item simple
  10750. Simple filter coefficient set.
  10751. @item complex
  10752. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  10753. @end table
  10754. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  10755. @item deint
  10756. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following values:
  10757. @table @samp
  10758. @item all
  10759. Deinterlace all frames,
  10760. @item interlaced
  10761. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  10762. @end table
  10763. Default value is @samp{all}.
  10764. @end table
  10765. @section waveform
  10766. Video waveform monitor.
  10767. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  10768. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  10769. source video.
  10770. It accepts the following options:
  10771. @table @option
  10772. @item mode, m
  10773. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  10774. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  10775. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  10776. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  10777. @item intensity, i
  10778. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  10779. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  10780. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  10781. @item mirror, r
  10782. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  10783. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  10784. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  10785. @code{1} (mirrored).
  10786. @item display, d
  10787. Set display mode.
  10788. It accepts the following values:
  10789. @table @samp
  10790. @item overlay
  10791. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  10792. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  10793. over one another.
  10794. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  10795. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  10796. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  10797. @item stack
  10798. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  10799. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  10800. @item parade
  10801. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  10802. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  10803. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  10804. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  10805. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  10806. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  10807. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  10808. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  10809. @end table
  10810. Default is @code{stack}.
  10811. @item components, c
  10812. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  10813. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  10814. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  10815. @item envelope, e
  10816. @table @samp
  10817. @item none
  10818. No envelope, this is default.
  10819. @item instant
  10820. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  10821. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  10822. @item peak
  10823. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  10824. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  10825. @item peak+instant
  10826. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  10827. @end table
  10828. @item filter, f
  10829. @table @samp
  10830. @item lowpass
  10831. No filtering, this is default.
  10832. @item flat
  10833. Luma and chroma combined together.
  10834. @item aflat
  10835. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  10836. @item chroma
  10837. Displays only chroma.
  10838. @item color
  10839. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  10840. @item acolor
  10841. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  10842. @end table
  10843. @item graticule, g
  10844. Set which graticule to display.
  10845. @table @samp
  10846. @item none
  10847. Do not display graticule.
  10848. @item green
  10849. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  10850. @end table
  10851. @item opacity, o
  10852. Set graticule opacity.
  10853. @item flags, fl
  10854. Set graticule flags.
  10855. @table @samp
  10856. @item numbers
  10857. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  10858. @item dots
  10859. Draw dots instead of lines.
  10860. @end table
  10861. @item scale, s
  10862. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  10863. @table @samp
  10864. @item digital
  10865. @item millivolts
  10866. @item ire
  10867. @end table
  10868. Default is digital.
  10869. @item bgopacity, b
  10870. Set background opacity.
  10871. @end table
  10872. @section weave
  10873. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  10874. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  10875. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  10876. It accepts the following option:
  10877. @table @option
  10878. @item first_field
  10879. Set first field. Available values are:
  10880. @table @samp
  10881. @item top, t
  10882. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  10883. @item bottom, b
  10884. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  10885. @end table
  10886. @end table
  10887. @subsection Examples
  10888. @itemize
  10889. @item
  10890. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  10891. @example
  10892. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  10893. @end example
  10894. @end itemize
  10895. @section xbr
  10896. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  10897. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  10898. @url{http://www.libretro.com/forums/viewtopic.php?f=6&t=134}.
  10899. It accepts the following option:
  10900. @table @option
  10901. @item n
  10902. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  10903. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  10904. Default is @code{3}.
  10905. @end table
  10906. @anchor{yadif}
  10907. @section yadif
  10908. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  10909. filter").
  10910. It accepts the following parameters:
  10911. @table @option
  10912. @item mode
  10913. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  10914. @table @option
  10915. @item 0, send_frame
  10916. Output one frame for each frame.
  10917. @item 1, send_field
  10918. Output one frame for each field.
  10919. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  10920. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10921. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  10922. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  10923. @end table
  10924. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  10925. @item parity
  10926. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  10927. of the following values:
  10928. @table @option
  10929. @item 0, tff
  10930. Assume the top field is first.
  10931. @item 1, bff
  10932. Assume the bottom field is first.
  10933. @item -1, auto
  10934. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  10935. @end table
  10936. The default value is @code{auto}.
  10937. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  10938. top field first will be assumed.
  10939. @item deint
  10940. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
  10941. values:
  10942. @table @option
  10943. @item 0, all
  10944. Deinterlace all frames.
  10945. @item 1, interlaced
  10946. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  10947. @end table
  10948. The default value is @code{all}.
  10949. @end table
  10950. @section zoompan
  10951. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  10952. This filter accepts the following options:
  10953. @table @option
  10954. @item zoom, z
  10955. Set the zoom expression. Default is 1.
  10956. @item x
  10957. @item y
  10958. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  10959. @item d
  10960. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  10961. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  10962. single input image.
  10963. @item s
  10964. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  10965. @item fps
  10966. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  10967. @end table
  10968. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  10969. @table @option
  10970. @item in_w, iw
  10971. Input width.
  10972. @item in_h, ih
  10973. Input height.
  10974. @item out_w, ow
  10975. Output width.
  10976. @item out_h, oh
  10977. Output height.
  10978. @item in
  10979. Input frame count.
  10980. @item on
  10981. Output frame count.
  10982. @item x
  10983. @item y
  10984. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  10985. for current input frame.
  10986. @item px
  10987. @item py
  10988. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  10989. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  10990. @item zoom
  10991. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  10992. @item pzoom
  10993. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  10994. @item duration
  10995. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  10996. for each input frame.
  10997. @item pduration
  10998. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  10999. @item a
  11000. Rational number: input width / input height
  11001. @item sar
  11002. sample aspect ratio
  11003. @item dar
  11004. display aspect ratio
  11005. @end table
  11006. @subsection Examples
  11007. @itemize
  11008. @item
  11009. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  11010. @example
  11011. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  11012. @end example
  11013. @item
  11014. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  11015. @example
  11016. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  11017. @end example
  11018. @item
  11019. Same as above but without pausing:
  11020. @example
  11021. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  11022. @end example
  11023. @end itemize
  11024. @section zscale
  11025. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  11026. https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg.
  11027. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  11028. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  11029. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  11030. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  11031. requested format.
  11032. @subsection Options
  11033. The filter accepts the following options.
  11034. @table @option
  11035. @item width, w
  11036. @item height, h
  11037. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  11038. dimension.
  11039. If the @var{width} or @var{w} is 0, the input width is used for the output.
  11040. If the @var{height} or @var{h} is 0, the input height is used for the output.
  11041. If one of the values is -1, the zscale filter will use a value that
  11042. maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
  11043. other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
  11044. used
  11045. If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the zscale filter will also use a value
  11046. that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
  11047. specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
  11048. dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
  11049. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  11050. expression.
  11051. @item size, s
  11052. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11053. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11054. @item dither, d
  11055. Set the dither type.
  11056. Possible values are:
  11057. @table @var
  11058. @item none
  11059. @item ordered
  11060. @item random
  11061. @item error_diffusion
  11062. @end table
  11063. Default is none.
  11064. @item filter, f
  11065. Set the resize filter type.
  11066. Possible values are:
  11067. @table @var
  11068. @item point
  11069. @item bilinear
  11070. @item bicubic
  11071. @item spline16
  11072. @item spline36
  11073. @item lanczos
  11074. @end table
  11075. Default is bilinear.
  11076. @item range, r
  11077. Set the color range.
  11078. Possible values are:
  11079. @table @var
  11080. @item input
  11081. @item limited
  11082. @item full
  11083. @end table
  11084. Default is same as input.
  11085. @item primaries, p
  11086. Set the color primaries.
  11087. Possible values are:
  11088. @table @var
  11089. @item input
  11090. @item 709
  11091. @item unspecified
  11092. @item 170m
  11093. @item 240m
  11094. @item 2020
  11095. @end table
  11096. Default is same as input.
  11097. @item transfer, t
  11098. Set the transfer characteristics.
  11099. Possible values are:
  11100. @table @var
  11101. @item input
  11102. @item 709
  11103. @item unspecified
  11104. @item 601
  11105. @item linear
  11106. @item 2020_10
  11107. @item 2020_12
  11108. @end table
  11109. Default is same as input.
  11110. @item matrix, m
  11111. Set the colorspace matrix.
  11112. Possible value are:
  11113. @table @var
  11114. @item input
  11115. @item 709
  11116. @item unspecified
  11117. @item 470bg
  11118. @item 170m
  11119. @item 2020_ncl
  11120. @item 2020_cl
  11121. @end table
  11122. Default is same as input.
  11123. @item rangein, rin
  11124. Set the input color range.
  11125. Possible values are:
  11126. @table @var
  11127. @item input
  11128. @item limited
  11129. @item full
  11130. @end table
  11131. Default is same as input.
  11132. @item primariesin, pin
  11133. Set the input color primaries.
  11134. Possible values are:
  11135. @table @var
  11136. @item input
  11137. @item 709
  11138. @item unspecified
  11139. @item 170m
  11140. @item 240m
  11141. @item 2020
  11142. @end table
  11143. Default is same as input.
  11144. @item transferin, tin
  11145. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  11146. Possible values are:
  11147. @table @var
  11148. @item input
  11149. @item 709
  11150. @item unspecified
  11151. @item 601
  11152. @item linear
  11153. @item 2020_10
  11154. @item 2020_12
  11155. @end table
  11156. Default is same as input.
  11157. @item matrixin, min
  11158. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  11159. Possible value are:
  11160. @table @var
  11161. @item input
  11162. @item 709
  11163. @item unspecified
  11164. @item 470bg
  11165. @item 170m
  11166. @item 2020_ncl
  11167. @item 2020_cl
  11168. @end table
  11169. @item chromal, c
  11170. Set the output chroma location.
  11171. Possible values are:
  11172. @table @var
  11173. @item input
  11174. @item left
  11175. @item center
  11176. @item topleft
  11177. @item top
  11178. @item bottomleft
  11179. @item bottom
  11180. @end table
  11181. @item chromalin, cin
  11182. Set the input chroma location.
  11183. Possible values are:
  11184. @table @var
  11185. @item input
  11186. @item left
  11187. @item center
  11188. @item topleft
  11189. @item top
  11190. @item bottomleft
  11191. @item bottom
  11192. @end table
  11193. @end table
  11194. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  11195. containing the following constants:
  11196. @table @var
  11197. @item in_w
  11198. @item in_h
  11199. The input width and height
  11200. @item iw
  11201. @item ih
  11202. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11203. @item out_w
  11204. @item out_h
  11205. The output (scaled) width and height
  11206. @item ow
  11207. @item oh
  11208. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  11209. @item a
  11210. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11211. @item sar
  11212. input sample aspect ratio
  11213. @item dar
  11214. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  11215. @item hsub
  11216. @item vsub
  11217. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11218. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11219. @item ohsub
  11220. @item ovsub
  11221. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11222. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11223. @end table
  11224. @table @option
  11225. @end table
  11226. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  11227. @chapter Video Sources
  11228. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  11229. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  11230. @section buffer
  11231. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  11232. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  11233. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  11234. It accepts the following parameters:
  11235. @table @option
  11236. @item video_size
  11237. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  11238. syntax of this option, check the
  11239. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11240. @item width
  11241. The input video width.
  11242. @item height
  11243. The input video height.
  11244. @item pix_fmt
  11245. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  11246. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  11247. name.
  11248. @item time_base
  11249. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  11250. @item frame_rate
  11251. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  11252. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  11253. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  11254. @item sws_param
  11255. Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
  11256. is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
  11257. input size or format.
  11258. @item hw_frames_ctx
  11259. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  11260. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  11261. @end table
  11262. For example:
  11263. @example
  11264. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  11265. @end example
  11266. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  11267. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  11268. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  11269. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  11270. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  11271. this example corresponds to:
  11272. @example
  11273. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  11274. @end example
  11275. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  11276. syntax is deprecated:
  11277. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
  11278. @section cellauto
  11279. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  11280. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  11281. @option{filename}, and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  11282. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  11283. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  11284. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  11285. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  11286. This source accepts the following options:
  11287. @table @option
  11288. @item filename, f
  11289. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  11290. the specified file.
  11291. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  11292. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  11293. file will be ignored.
  11294. @item pattern, p
  11295. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  11296. the specified string.
  11297. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  11298. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  11299. string will be ignored.
  11300. @item rate, r
  11301. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  11302. Default is 25.
  11303. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  11304. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  11305. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  11306. 1/PHI.
  11307. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  11308. @item random_seed, seed
  11309. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  11310. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  11311. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  11312. effort basis.
  11313. @item rule
  11314. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  11315. Default value is 110.
  11316. @item size, s
  11317. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11318. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11319. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  11320. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  11321. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  11322. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  11323. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  11324. larger row.
  11325. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  11326. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  11327. @item scroll
  11328. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  11329. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  11330. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  11331. Defaults to 1.
  11332. @item start_full, full
  11333. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  11334. outputting the first frame.
  11335. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  11336. @item stitch
  11337. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  11338. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  11339. @end table
  11340. @subsection Examples
  11341. @itemize
  11342. @item
  11343. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  11344. size 200x400.
  11345. @example
  11346. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  11347. @end example
  11348. @item
  11349. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  11350. ratio of 2/3:
  11351. @example
  11352. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  11353. @end example
  11354. @item
  11355. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  11356. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  11357. @example
  11358. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  11359. @end example
  11360. @item
  11361. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  11362. @example
  11363. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  11364. @end example
  11365. @end itemize
  11366. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  11367. @section coreimagesrc
  11368. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  11369. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  11370. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  11371. generate the content.
  11372. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  11373. @table @option
  11374. @item list_generators
  11375. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  11376. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  11377. @example
  11378. list_generators=true
  11379. @end example
  11380. @item size, s
  11381. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11382. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11383. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  11384. @item rate, r
  11385. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11386. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11387. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11388. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11389. "25".
  11390. @item sar
  11391. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  11392. @item duration, d
  11393. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11394. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11395. for the accepted syntax.
  11396. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11397. supposed to be generated forever.
  11398. @end table
  11399. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  11400. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  11401. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  11402. and examples for details.
  11403. @subsection Examples
  11404. @itemize
  11405. @item
  11406. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  11407. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  11408. @example
  11409. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  11410. @end example
  11411. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  11412. need for a nullsrc video source.
  11413. @end itemize
  11414. @section mandelbrot
  11415. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  11416. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  11417. This source accepts the following options:
  11418. @table @option
  11419. @item end_pts
  11420. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  11421. @item end_scale
  11422. Set the terminal scale value.
  11423. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  11424. @item inner
  11425. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  11426. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  11427. It shall assume one of the following values:
  11428. @table @option
  11429. @item black
  11430. Set black mode.
  11431. @item convergence
  11432. Show time until convergence.
  11433. @item mincol
  11434. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  11435. @item period
  11436. Set period mode.
  11437. @end table
  11438. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  11439. @item bailout
  11440. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  11441. @item maxiter
  11442. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  11443. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  11444. @item outer
  11445. Set outer coloring mode.
  11446. It shall assume one of following values:
  11447. @table @option
  11448. @item iteration_count
  11449. Set iteration cound mode.
  11450. @item normalized_iteration_count
  11451. set normalized iteration count mode.
  11452. @end table
  11453. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  11454. @item rate, r
  11455. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  11456. value is "25".
  11457. @item size, s
  11458. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
  11459. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default value is "640x480".
  11460. @item start_scale
  11461. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  11462. @item start_x
  11463. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  11464. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  11465. @item start_y
  11466. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  11467. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  11468. @end table
  11469. @section mptestsrc
  11470. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  11471. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  11472. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  11473. This source accepts the following options:
  11474. @table @option
  11475. @item rate, r
  11476. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11477. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11478. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11479. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11480. "25".
  11481. @item duration, d
  11482. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11483. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11484. for the accepted syntax.
  11485. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11486. supposed to be generated forever.
  11487. @item test, t
  11488. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  11489. @table @option
  11490. @item dc_luma
  11491. @item dc_chroma
  11492. @item freq_luma
  11493. @item freq_chroma
  11494. @item amp_luma
  11495. @item amp_chroma
  11496. @item cbp
  11497. @item mv
  11498. @item ring1
  11499. @item ring2
  11500. @item all
  11501. @end table
  11502. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  11503. @end table
  11504. Some examples:
  11505. @example
  11506. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  11507. @end example
  11508. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  11509. @section frei0r_src
  11510. Provide a frei0r source.
  11511. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  11512. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  11513. This source accepts the following parameters:
  11514. @table @option
  11515. @item size
  11516. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11517. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11518. @item framerate
  11519. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  11520. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  11521. @item filter_name
  11522. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  11523. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  11524. documentation.
  11525. @item filter_params
  11526. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  11527. @end table
  11528. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  11529. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  11530. @example
  11531. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  11532. @end example
  11533. @section life
  11534. Generate a life pattern.
  11535. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  11536. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  11537. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  11538. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  11539. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  11540. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  11541. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  11542. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  11543. the rule to adopt.
  11544. This source accepts the following options:
  11545. @table @option
  11546. @item filename, f
  11547. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  11548. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  11549. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  11550. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  11551. randomly.
  11552. @item rate, r
  11553. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  11554. Default is 25.
  11555. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  11556. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  11557. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  11558. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  11559. @item random_seed, seed
  11560. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  11561. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  11562. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  11563. effort basis.
  11564. @item rule
  11565. Set the life rule.
  11566. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  11567. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  11568. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  11569. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  11570. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  11571. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  11572. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  11573. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  11574. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  11575. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  11576. higher number of neighbor cells.
  11577. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  11578. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  11579. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  11580. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  11581. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  11582. a dead cell.
  11583. @item size, s
  11584. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11585. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11586. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  11587. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  11588. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  11589. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  11590. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  11591. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  11592. @item stitch
  11593. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  11594. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  11595. @item mold
  11596. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  11597. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  11598. value from 0 to 255.
  11599. @item life_color
  11600. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  11601. @item death_color
  11602. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  11603. used to represent a dead cell.
  11604. @item mold_color
  11605. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  11606. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the
  11607. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  11608. @end table
  11609. @subsection Examples
  11610. @itemize
  11611. @item
  11612. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  11613. 300x300 pixels:
  11614. @example
  11615. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  11616. @end example
  11617. @item
  11618. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  11619. @example
  11620. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  11621. @end example
  11622. @item
  11623. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  11624. @example
  11625. life=rule=S14/B34
  11626. @end example
  11627. @item
  11628. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  11629. @example
  11630. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  11631. @end example
  11632. @end itemize
  11633. @anchor{allrgb}
  11634. @anchor{allyuv}
  11635. @anchor{color}
  11636. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  11637. @anchor{nullsrc}
  11638. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  11639. @anchor{smptebars}
  11640. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  11641. @anchor{testsrc}
  11642. @anchor{testsrc2}
  11643. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  11644. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  11645. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  11646. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  11647. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  11648. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  11649. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  11650. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  11651. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  11652. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  11653. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  11654. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  11655. stripe from top to bottom.
  11656. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  11657. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  11658. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  11659. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  11660. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  11661. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  11662. intended for testing purposes.
  11663. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  11664. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  11665. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  11666. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  11667. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  11668. The sources accept the following parameters:
  11669. @table @option
  11670. @item color, c
  11671. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  11672. source. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
  11673. ffmpeg-utils manual.
  11674. @item level
  11675. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  11676. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  11677. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  11678. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  11679. @item size, s
  11680. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11681. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11682. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  11683. This option is not available with the @code{haldclutsrc} filter.
  11684. @item rate, r
  11685. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  11686. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  11687. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  11688. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  11689. "25".
  11690. @item sar
  11691. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  11692. @item duration, d
  11693. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  11694. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  11695. for the accepted syntax.
  11696. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  11697. supposed to be generated forever.
  11698. @item decimals, n
  11699. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  11700. @code{testsrc} source.
  11701. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  11702. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  11703. value. Default value is 0.
  11704. @end table
  11705. For example the following:
  11706. @example
  11707. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  11708. @end example
  11709. will generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  11710. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second.
  11711. The following graph description will generate a red source
  11712. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  11713. frames per second.
  11714. @example
  11715. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  11716. @end example
  11717. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  11718. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  11719. the @code{geq} filter:
  11720. @example
  11721. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  11722. @end example
  11723. @subsection Commands
  11724. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  11725. @table @option
  11726. @item c, color
  11727. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  11728. corresponding @option{color} option.
  11729. @end table
  11730. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  11731. @chapter Video Sinks
  11732. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  11733. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  11734. @section buffersink
  11735. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  11736. graph.
  11737. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  11738. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  11739. or the options system.
  11740. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  11741. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  11742. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  11743. @section nullsink
  11744. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  11745. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  11746. tools.
  11747. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  11748. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  11749. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  11750. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  11751. @section ahistogram
  11752. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  11753. The filter accepts the following options:
  11754. @table @option
  11755. @item dmode
  11756. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  11757. It accepts the following values:
  11758. @table @samp
  11759. @item single
  11760. Use single histogram for all channels.
  11761. @item separate
  11762. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  11763. @end table
  11764. Default is @code{single}.
  11765. @item rate, r
  11766. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  11767. value is "25".
  11768. @item size, s
  11769. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11770. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11771. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  11772. @item scale
  11773. Set display scale.
  11774. It accepts the following values:
  11775. @table @samp
  11776. @item log
  11777. logarithmic
  11778. @item sqrt
  11779. square root
  11780. @item cbrt
  11781. cubic root
  11782. @item lin
  11783. linear
  11784. @item rlog
  11785. reverse logarithmic
  11786. @end table
  11787. Default is @code{log}.
  11788. @item ascale
  11789. Set amplitude scale.
  11790. It accepts the following values:
  11791. @table @samp
  11792. @item log
  11793. logarithmic
  11794. @item lin
  11795. linear
  11796. @end table
  11797. Default is @code{log}.
  11798. @item acount
  11799. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  11800. Defauls is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  11801. @item rheight
  11802. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  11803. @item slide
  11804. Set sonogram sliding.
  11805. It accepts the following values:
  11806. @table @samp
  11807. @item replace
  11808. replace old rows with new ones.
  11809. @item scroll
  11810. scroll from top to bottom.
  11811. @end table
  11812. Default is @code{replace}.
  11813. @end table
  11814. @section aphasemeter
  11815. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio phase.
  11816. The filter accepts the following options:
  11817. @table @option
  11818. @item rate, r
  11819. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  11820. @item size, s
  11821. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11822. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11823. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  11824. @item rc
  11825. @item gc
  11826. @item bc
  11827. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  11828. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  11829. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11830. @item mpc
  11831. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  11832. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  11833. @end table
  11834. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase} which
  11835. represents mean phase of current audio frame. Value is in range @code{[-1, 1]}.
  11836. The @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase and
  11837. @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  11838. @section avectorscope
  11839. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  11840. scope.
  11841. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  11842. audio stream. A monoaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  11843. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  11844. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  11845. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  11846. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  11847. The filter accepts the following options:
  11848. @table @option
  11849. @item mode, m
  11850. Set the vectorscope mode.
  11851. Available values are:
  11852. @table @samp
  11853. @item lissajous
  11854. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  11855. @item lissajous_xy
  11856. Same as above but not rotated.
  11857. @item polar
  11858. Shape resembling half of circle.
  11859. @end table
  11860. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  11861. @item size, s
  11862. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  11863. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11864. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  11865. @item rate, r
  11866. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  11867. @item rc
  11868. @item gc
  11869. @item bc
  11870. @item ac
  11871. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  11872. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  11873. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11874. @item rf
  11875. @item gf
  11876. @item bf
  11877. @item af
  11878. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  11879. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  11880. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  11881. @item zoom
  11882. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[1, 10]}.
  11883. @item draw
  11884. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  11885. Available values are:
  11886. @table @samp
  11887. @item dot
  11888. Draw dot for each sample.
  11889. @item line
  11890. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  11891. @end table
  11892. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  11893. @item scale
  11894. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  11895. Available values are:
  11896. @table @samp
  11897. @item lin
  11898. Linear.
  11899. @item sqrt
  11900. Square root.
  11901. @item cbrt
  11902. Cubic root.
  11903. @item log
  11904. Logarithmic.
  11905. @end table
  11906. @end table
  11907. @subsection Examples
  11908. @itemize
  11909. @item
  11910. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  11911. @example
  11912. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  11913. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  11914. @end example
  11915. @end itemize
  11916. @section bench, abench
  11917. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  11918. The filter accepts the following options:
  11919. @table @option
  11920. @item action
  11921. Start or stop a timer.
  11922. Available values are:
  11923. @table @samp
  11924. @item start
  11925. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  11926. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  11927. @item stop
  11928. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  11929. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  11930. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  11931. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  11932. @end table
  11933. @end table
  11934. @subsection Examples
  11935. @itemize
  11936. @item
  11937. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  11938. @example
  11939. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  11940. @end example
  11941. @end itemize
  11942. @section concat
  11943. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  11944. other.
  11945. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  11946. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  11947. also be the number of streams at output.
  11948. The filter accepts the following options:
  11949. @table @option
  11950. @item n
  11951. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  11952. @item v
  11953. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  11954. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  11955. @item a
  11956. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  11957. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  11958. @item unsafe
  11959. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  11960. @end table
  11961. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  11962. @var{a} audio outputs.
  11963. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  11964. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  11965. segment, etc.
  11966. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  11967. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  11968. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  11969. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  11970. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  11971. audio streams with silence.
  11972. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  11973. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  11974. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  11975. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  11976. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  11977. explicitly by the user.
  11978. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  11979. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  11980. @subsection Examples
  11981. @itemize
  11982. @item
  11983. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  11984. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  11985. @example
  11986. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  11987. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  11988. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  11989. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  11990. @end example
  11991. @item
  11992. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  11993. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  11994. @example
  11995. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  11996. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  11997. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  11998. @end example
  11999. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  12000. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  12001. @end itemize
  12002. @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
  12003. Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
  12004. It accepts the following parameters:
  12005. @table @option
  12006. @item m1
  12007. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12008. @item fg1
  12009. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  12010. @item m2
  12011. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12012. @item fg2
  12013. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  12014. @item m3
  12015. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12016. @item fg3
  12017. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  12018. @item m4
  12019. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  12020. @item fg4
  12021. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  12022. @item min
  12023. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  12024. @item max
  12025. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  12026. @item bg
  12027. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  12028. @item mode
  12029. Set graph mode.
  12030. Available values for mode is:
  12031. @table @samp
  12032. @item bar
  12033. @item dot
  12034. @item line
  12035. @end table
  12036. Default is @code{line}.
  12037. @item slide
  12038. Set slide mode.
  12039. Available values for slide is:
  12040. @table @samp
  12041. @item frame
  12042. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  12043. @item replace
  12044. Replace old columns with new ones.
  12045. @item scroll
  12046. Scroll from right to left.
  12047. @item rscroll
  12048. Scroll from left to right.
  12049. @item picture
  12050. Draw single picture.
  12051. @end table
  12052. Default is @code{frame}.
  12053. @item size
  12054. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12055. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12056. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  12057. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  12058. @table @option
  12059. @item MIN
  12060. Minimal value of metadata value.
  12061. @item MAX
  12062. Maximal value of metadata value.
  12063. @item VAL
  12064. Current metadata key value.
  12065. @end table
  12066. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  12067. @end table
  12068. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  12069. @example
  12070. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  12071. @end example
  12072. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  12073. @example
  12074. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  12075. @end example
  12076. @anchor{ebur128}
  12077. @section ebur128
  12078. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as input and outputs
  12079. it unchanged. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  12080. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  12081. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  12082. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  12083. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  12084. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  12085. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  12086. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  12087. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds).
  12088. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  12089. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  12090. The filter accepts the following options:
  12091. @table @option
  12092. @item video
  12093. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  12094. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  12095. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  12096. @item size
  12097. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  12098. option, check the
  12099. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12100. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  12101. @item meter
  12102. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  12103. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  12104. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  12105. @item metadata
  12106. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  12107. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  12108. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  12109. Default is @code{0}.
  12110. @item framelog
  12111. Force the frame logging level.
  12112. Available values are:
  12113. @table @samp
  12114. @item info
  12115. information logging level
  12116. @item verbose
  12117. verbose logging level
  12118. @end table
  12119. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  12120. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  12121. @item peak
  12122. Set peak mode(s).
  12123. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  12124. values are:
  12125. @table @samp
  12126. @item none
  12127. Disable any peak mode (default).
  12128. @item sample
  12129. Enable sample-peak mode.
  12130. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  12131. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  12132. @item true
  12133. Enable true-peak mode.
  12134. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  12135. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  12136. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  12137. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  12138. @end table
  12139. @item dualmono
  12140. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  12141. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  12142. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  12143. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  12144. @item panlaw
  12145. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  12146. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  12147. @end table
  12148. @subsection Examples
  12149. @itemize
  12150. @item
  12151. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  12152. @example
  12153. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  12154. @end example
  12155. @item
  12156. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  12157. @example
  12158. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  12159. @end example
  12160. @end itemize
  12161. @section interleave, ainterleave
  12162. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  12163. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  12164. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  12165. queued frame to the output.
  12166. Input streams must have a well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  12167. timestamp values.
  12168. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  12169. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  12170. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  12171. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  12172. which always drop input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  12173. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  12174. to output until the input will send an end-of-stream signal.
  12175. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  12176. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  12177. the queue is already filled.
  12178. These filters accept the following options:
  12179. @table @option
  12180. @item nb_inputs, n
  12181. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  12182. @end table
  12183. @subsection Examples
  12184. @itemize
  12185. @item
  12186. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  12187. @example
  12188. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  12189. @end example
  12190. @item
  12191. Add flickering blur effect:
  12192. @example
  12193. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  12194. @end example
  12195. @end itemize
  12196. @section metadata, ametadata
  12197. Manipulate frame metadata.
  12198. This filter accepts the following options:
  12199. @table @option
  12200. @item mode
  12201. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  12202. Can be one of the following:
  12203. @table @samp
  12204. @item select
  12205. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  12206. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  12207. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  12208. @item add
  12209. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  12210. do nothing.
  12211. @item modify
  12212. Modify value of already present key.
  12213. @item delete
  12214. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  12215. Otherwise, delete key.
  12216. @item print
  12217. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  12218. metadata values available in frame.
  12219. @end table
  12220. @item key
  12221. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print}.
  12222. @item value
  12223. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  12224. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  12225. @item function
  12226. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  12227. Can be one of following:
  12228. @table @samp
  12229. @item same_str
  12230. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  12231. @item starts_with
  12232. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  12233. the @code{value} option string.
  12234. @item less
  12235. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  12236. @item equal
  12237. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  12238. @item greater
  12239. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  12240. @item expr
  12241. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  12242. evaluates to true.
  12243. @end table
  12244. @item expr
  12245. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  12246. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  12247. constants:
  12248. @table @option
  12249. @item VALUE1
  12250. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  12251. @item VALUE2
  12252. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  12253. @item file
  12254. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  12255. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  12256. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  12257. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  12258. @end table
  12259. @end table
  12260. @subsection Examples
  12261. @itemize
  12262. @item
  12263. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.singnalstats.YDIF} with values
  12264. between 0 and 1.
  12265. @example
  12266. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  12267. @end example
  12268. @item
  12269. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  12270. @example
  12271. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  12272. @end example
  12273. @item
  12274. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  12275. @example
  12276. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  12277. @end example
  12278. @end itemize
  12279. @section perms, aperms
  12280. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  12281. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  12282. following filter in the filtergraph.
  12283. The filters accept the following options:
  12284. @table @option
  12285. @item mode
  12286. Select the permissions mode.
  12287. It accepts the following values:
  12288. @table @samp
  12289. @item none
  12290. Do nothing. This is the default.
  12291. @item ro
  12292. Set all the output frames read-only.
  12293. @item rw
  12294. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  12295. @item toggle
  12296. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  12297. @item random
  12298. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  12299. @end table
  12300. @item seed
  12301. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  12302. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  12303. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  12304. basis.
  12305. @end table
  12306. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  12307. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  12308. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  12309. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  12310. @section realtime, arealtime
  12311. Slow down filtering to match real time approximatively.
  12312. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  12313. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  12314. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  12315. They accept the following options:
  12316. @table @option
  12317. @item limit
  12318. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  12319. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  12320. @end table
  12321. @anchor{select}
  12322. @section select, aselect
  12323. Select frames to pass in output.
  12324. This filter accepts the following options:
  12325. @table @option
  12326. @item expr, e
  12327. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  12328. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  12329. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  12330. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  12331. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  12332. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  12333. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  12334. @item outputs, n
  12335. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  12336. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  12337. @end table
  12338. The expression can contain the following constants:
  12339. @table @option
  12340. @item n
  12341. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  12342. @item selected_n
  12343. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  12344. @item prev_selected_n
  12345. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12346. @item TB
  12347. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  12348. @item pts
  12349. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  12350. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  12351. @item t
  12352. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  12353. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  12354. @item prev_pts
  12355. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12356. @item prev_selected_pts
  12357. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12358. @item prev_selected_t
  12359. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  12360. @item start_pts
  12361. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  12362. @item start_t
  12363. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  12364. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  12365. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  12366. values:
  12367. @table @option
  12368. @item I
  12369. @item P
  12370. @item B
  12371. @item S
  12372. @item SI
  12373. @item SP
  12374. @item BI
  12375. @end table
  12376. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  12377. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  12378. @table @option
  12379. @item PROGRESSIVE
  12380. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  12381. @item TOPFIRST
  12382. The frame is top-field-first.
  12383. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  12384. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  12385. @end table
  12386. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  12387. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  12388. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  12389. the number of samples in the current frame
  12390. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  12391. the input sample rate
  12392. @item key
  12393. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  12394. @item pos
  12395. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  12396. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  12397. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  12398. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  12399. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  12400. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  12401. @item concatdec_select
  12402. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  12403. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  12404. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  12405. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  12406. interval.
  12407. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  12408. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  12409. present in the decoded frames.
  12410. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  12411. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  12412. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  12413. missing.
  12414. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  12415. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  12416. @end table
  12417. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  12418. @subsection Examples
  12419. @itemize
  12420. @item
  12421. Select all frames in input:
  12422. @example
  12423. select
  12424. @end example
  12425. The example above is the same as:
  12426. @example
  12427. select=1
  12428. @end example
  12429. @item
  12430. Skip all frames:
  12431. @example
  12432. select=0
  12433. @end example
  12434. @item
  12435. Select only I-frames:
  12436. @example
  12437. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  12438. @end example
  12439. @item
  12440. Select one frame every 100:
  12441. @example
  12442. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  12443. @end example
  12444. @item
  12445. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  12446. @example
  12447. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  12448. @end example
  12449. @item
  12450. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  12451. @example
  12452. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  12453. @end example
  12454. @item
  12455. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  12456. @example
  12457. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  12458. @end example
  12459. @item
  12460. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  12461. @example
  12462. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  12463. @end example
  12464. @item
  12465. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  12466. @example
  12467. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  12468. @end example
  12469. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  12470. choice.
  12471. @item
  12472. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  12473. @example
  12474. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  12475. @end example
  12476. @item
  12477. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  12478. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  12479. @example
  12480. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  12481. @end example
  12482. @end itemize
  12483. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  12484. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  12485. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  12486. filtergraph.
  12487. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  12488. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  12489. from that they act the same way.
  12490. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  12491. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  12492. @var{filename} option.
  12493. These filters accept the following options:
  12494. @table @option
  12495. @item commands, c
  12496. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  12497. @item filename, f
  12498. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  12499. filters.
  12500. @end table
  12501. @subsection Commands syntax
  12502. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  12503. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  12504. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  12505. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  12506. interval.
  12507. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  12508. @example
  12509. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  12510. @end example
  12511. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  12512. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  12513. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  12514. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  12515. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  12516. @var{END}.
  12517. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  12518. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  12519. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  12520. @example
  12521. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  12522. @end example
  12523. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  12524. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  12525. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  12526. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  12527. The following flags are recognized:
  12528. @table @option
  12529. @item enter
  12530. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  12531. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  12532. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  12533. current is.
  12534. @item leave
  12535. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  12536. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  12537. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  12538. current is not.
  12539. @end table
  12540. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  12541. assumed.
  12542. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  12543. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  12544. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  12545. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  12546. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  12547. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  12548. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  12549. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  12550. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  12551. follows:
  12552. @example
  12553. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  12554. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  12555. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  12556. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  12557. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  12558. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  12559. @end example
  12560. @subsection Examples
  12561. @itemize
  12562. @item
  12563. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  12564. @example
  12565. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  12566. @end example
  12567. @item
  12568. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  12569. @example
  12570. # show text in the interval 5-10
  12571. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  12572. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  12573. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  12574. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  12575. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  12576. [leave] hue s 1,
  12577. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  12578. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  12579. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  12580. @end example
  12581. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  12582. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  12583. @example
  12584. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  12585. @end example
  12586. @end itemize
  12587. @anchor{setpts}
  12588. @section setpts, asetpts
  12589. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  12590. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  12591. This filter accepts the following options:
  12592. @table @option
  12593. @item expr
  12594. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  12595. @end table
  12596. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  12597. constants:
  12598. @table @option
  12599. @item FRAME_RATE
  12600. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  12601. @item PTS
  12602. The presentation timestamp in input
  12603. @item N
  12604. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  12605. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  12606. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  12607. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  12608. audio)
  12609. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  12610. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  12611. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  12612. The audio sample rate.
  12613. @item STARTPTS
  12614. The PTS of the first frame.
  12615. @item STARTT
  12616. the time in seconds of the first frame
  12617. @item INTERLACED
  12618. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  12619. @item T
  12620. the time in seconds of the current frame
  12621. @item POS
  12622. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  12623. for the current frame
  12624. @item PREV_INPTS
  12625. The previous input PTS.
  12626. @item PREV_INT
  12627. previous input time in seconds
  12628. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  12629. The previous output PTS.
  12630. @item PREV_OUTT
  12631. previous output time in seconds
  12632. @item RTCTIME
  12633. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  12634. instead.
  12635. @item RTCSTART
  12636. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  12637. @item TB
  12638. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  12639. @end table
  12640. @subsection Examples
  12641. @itemize
  12642. @item
  12643. Start counting PTS from zero
  12644. @example
  12645. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  12646. @end example
  12647. @item
  12648. Apply fast motion effect:
  12649. @example
  12650. setpts=0.5*PTS
  12651. @end example
  12652. @item
  12653. Apply slow motion effect:
  12654. @example
  12655. setpts=2.0*PTS
  12656. @end example
  12657. @item
  12658. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  12659. @example
  12660. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  12661. @end example
  12662. @item
  12663. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  12664. @example
  12665. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  12666. @end example
  12667. @item
  12668. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  12669. @example
  12670. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  12671. @end example
  12672. @item
  12673. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  12674. @example
  12675. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  12676. @end example
  12677. @item
  12678. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  12679. @example
  12680. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  12681. @end example
  12682. @end itemize
  12683. @section settb, asettb
  12684. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  12685. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  12686. It accepts the following parameters:
  12687. @table @option
  12688. @item expr, tb
  12689. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  12690. @end table
  12691. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  12692. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  12693. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  12694. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  12695. @subsection Examples
  12696. @itemize
  12697. @item
  12698. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  12699. @example
  12700. settb=expr=1/25
  12701. @end example
  12702. @item
  12703. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  12704. @example
  12705. settb=expr=0.1
  12706. @end example
  12707. @item
  12708. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  12709. @example
  12710. settb=1+0.001
  12711. @end example
  12712. @item
  12713. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  12714. @example
  12715. settb=2*intb
  12716. @end example
  12717. @item
  12718. Set the default timebase value:
  12719. @example
  12720. settb=AVTB
  12721. @end example
  12722. @end itemize
  12723. @section showcqt
  12724. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  12725. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  12726. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  12727. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  12728. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  12729. The filter accepts the following options:
  12730. @table @option
  12731. @item size, s
  12732. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  12733. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12734. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  12735. @item fps, rate, r
  12736. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  12737. @item bar_h
  12738. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  12739. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  12740. @item axis_h
  12741. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  12742. the axis height automatically.
  12743. @item sono_h
  12744. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  12745. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  12746. @item fullhd
  12747. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  12748. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  12749. @item sono_v, volume
  12750. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  12751. @table @option
  12752. @item bar_v
  12753. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  12754. @item frequency, freq, f
  12755. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12756. @item timeclamp, tc
  12757. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12758. @end table
  12759. and functions:
  12760. @table @option
  12761. @item a_weighting(f)
  12762. A-weighting of equal loudness
  12763. @item b_weighting(f)
  12764. B-weighting of equal loudness
  12765. @item c_weighting(f)
  12766. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  12767. @end table
  12768. Default value is @code{16}.
  12769. @item bar_v, volume2
  12770. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  12771. @table @option
  12772. @item sono_v
  12773. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  12774. @item frequency, freq, f
  12775. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12776. @item timeclamp, tc
  12777. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12778. @end table
  12779. and functions:
  12780. @table @option
  12781. @item a_weighting(f)
  12782. A-weighting of equal loudness
  12783. @item b_weighting(f)
  12784. B-weighting of equal loudness
  12785. @item c_weighting(f)
  12786. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  12787. @end table
  12788. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  12789. @item sono_g, gamma
  12790. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  12791. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  12792. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  12793. @item bar_g, gamma2
  12794. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  12795. @code{[1, 7]}.
  12796. @item timeclamp, tc
  12797. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  12798. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  12799. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  12800. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  12801. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.1, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  12802. @item basefreq
  12803. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  12804. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  12805. @item endfreq
  12806. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  12807. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  12808. @item coeffclamp
  12809. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  12810. @item tlength
  12811. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  12812. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  12813. It can contain variables:
  12814. @table @option
  12815. @item frequency, freq, f
  12816. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12817. @item timeclamp, tc
  12818. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  12819. @end table
  12820. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  12821. @item count
  12822. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  12823. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  12824. @item fcount
  12825. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  12826. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  12827. @item fontfile
  12828. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  12829. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  12830. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  12831. option instead.
  12832. @item fontcolor
  12833. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  12834. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  12835. @table @option
  12836. @item frequency, freq, f
  12837. the frequency where it is evaluated
  12838. @item timeclamp, tc
  12839. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  12840. @end table
  12841. and functions:
  12842. @table @option
  12843. @item midi(f)
  12844. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  12845. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  12846. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  12847. @end table
  12848. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  12849. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  12850. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  12851. @item axisfile
  12852. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  12853. @var{fontcolor} option.
  12854. @item axis, text
  12855. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  12856. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  12857. Default value is @code{1}.
  12858. @end table
  12859. @subsection Examples
  12860. @itemize
  12861. @item
  12862. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  12863. @example
  12864. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  12865. @end example
  12866. @item
  12867. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  12868. @example
  12869. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  12870. @end example
  12871. @item
  12872. Playing at 1280x720:
  12873. @example
  12874. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  12875. @end example
  12876. @item
  12877. Disable sonogram display:
  12878. @example
  12879. sono_h=0
  12880. @end example
  12881. @item
  12882. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  12883. @example
  12884. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  12885. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  12886. @end example
  12887. @item
  12888. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  12889. @example
  12890. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  12891. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  12892. @end example
  12893. @item
  12894. Custom volume:
  12895. @example
  12896. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  12897. @end example
  12898. @item
  12899. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  12900. @example
  12901. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  12902. @end example
  12903. @item
  12904. Custom tlength equation:
  12905. @example
  12906. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  12907. @end example
  12908. @item
  12909. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  12910. @example
  12911. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  12912. @end example
  12913. @item
  12914. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  12915. @example
  12916. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  12917. @end example
  12918. @end itemize
  12919. @section showfreqs
  12920. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  12921. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  12922. The filter accepts the following options:
  12923. @table @option
  12924. @item size, s
  12925. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12926. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12927. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  12928. @item mode
  12929. Set display mode.
  12930. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  12931. It accepts the following values:
  12932. @table @samp
  12933. @item line
  12934. @item bar
  12935. @item dot
  12936. @end table
  12937. Default is @code{bar}.
  12938. @item ascale
  12939. Set amplitude scale.
  12940. It accepts the following values:
  12941. @table @samp
  12942. @item lin
  12943. Linear scale.
  12944. @item sqrt
  12945. Square root scale.
  12946. @item cbrt
  12947. Cubic root scale.
  12948. @item log
  12949. Logarithmic scale.
  12950. @end table
  12951. Default is @code{log}.
  12952. @item fscale
  12953. Set frequency scale.
  12954. It accepts the following values:
  12955. @table @samp
  12956. @item lin
  12957. Linear scale.
  12958. @item log
  12959. Logarithmic scale.
  12960. @item rlog
  12961. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  12962. @end table
  12963. Default is @code{lin}.
  12964. @item win_size
  12965. Set window size.
  12966. It accepts the following values:
  12967. @table @samp
  12968. @item w16
  12969. @item w32
  12970. @item w64
  12971. @item w128
  12972. @item w256
  12973. @item w512
  12974. @item w1024
  12975. @item w2048
  12976. @item w4096
  12977. @item w8192
  12978. @item w16384
  12979. @item w32768
  12980. @item w65536
  12981. @end table
  12982. Default is @code{w2048}
  12983. @item win_func
  12984. Set windowing function.
  12985. It accepts the following values:
  12986. @table @samp
  12987. @item rect
  12988. @item bartlett
  12989. @item hanning
  12990. @item hamming
  12991. @item blackman
  12992. @item welch
  12993. @item flattop
  12994. @item bharris
  12995. @item bnuttall
  12996. @item bhann
  12997. @item sine
  12998. @item nuttall
  12999. @item lanczos
  13000. @item gauss
  13001. @item tukey
  13002. @item dolph
  13003. @item cauchy
  13004. @item parzen
  13005. @item poisson
  13006. @end table
  13007. Default is @code{hanning}.
  13008. @item overlap
  13009. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  13010. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  13011. @item averaging
  13012. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  13013. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  13014. @item colors
  13015. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  13016. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  13017. by white color.
  13018. @item cmode
  13019. Set channel display mode.
  13020. It accepts the following values:
  13021. @table @samp
  13022. @item combined
  13023. @item separate
  13024. @end table
  13025. Default is @code{combined}.
  13026. @item minamp
  13027. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  13028. @end table
  13029. @anchor{showspectrum}
  13030. @section showspectrum
  13031. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  13032. spectrum.
  13033. The filter accepts the following options:
  13034. @table @option
  13035. @item size, s
  13036. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13037. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13038. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  13039. @item slide
  13040. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  13041. It accepts the following values:
  13042. @table @samp
  13043. @item replace
  13044. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  13045. @item scroll
  13046. the samples scroll from right to left
  13047. @item fullframe
  13048. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  13049. @item rscroll
  13050. the samples scroll from left to right
  13051. @end table
  13052. Default value is @code{replace}.
  13053. @item mode
  13054. Specify display mode.
  13055. It accepts the following values:
  13056. @table @samp
  13057. @item combined
  13058. all channels are displayed in the same row
  13059. @item separate
  13060. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  13061. @end table
  13062. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  13063. @item color
  13064. Specify display color mode.
  13065. It accepts the following values:
  13066. @table @samp
  13067. @item channel
  13068. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  13069. @item intensity
  13070. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  13071. @item rainbow
  13072. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  13073. @item moreland
  13074. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  13075. @item nebulae
  13076. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  13077. @item fire
  13078. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  13079. @item fiery
  13080. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  13081. @item fruit
  13082. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  13083. @item cool
  13084. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  13085. @end table
  13086. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  13087. @item scale
  13088. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  13089. It accepts the following values:
  13090. @table @samp
  13091. @item lin
  13092. linear
  13093. @item sqrt
  13094. square root, default
  13095. @item cbrt
  13096. cubic root
  13097. @item log
  13098. logarithmic
  13099. @item 4thrt
  13100. 4th root
  13101. @item 5thrt
  13102. 5th root
  13103. @end table
  13104. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  13105. @item saturation
  13106. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  13107. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  13108. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  13109. Default value is @code{1}.
  13110. @item win_func
  13111. Set window function.
  13112. It accepts the following values:
  13113. @table @samp
  13114. @item rect
  13115. @item bartlett
  13116. @item hann
  13117. @item hanning
  13118. @item hamming
  13119. @item blackman
  13120. @item welch
  13121. @item flattop
  13122. @item bharris
  13123. @item bnuttall
  13124. @item bhann
  13125. @item sine
  13126. @item nuttall
  13127. @item lanczos
  13128. @item gauss
  13129. @item tukey
  13130. @item dolph
  13131. @item cauchy
  13132. @item parzen
  13133. @item poisson
  13134. @end table
  13135. Default value is @code{hann}.
  13136. @item orientation
  13137. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  13138. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13139. @item overlap
  13140. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  13141. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  13142. window function currently used.
  13143. @item gain
  13144. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  13145. Default value is @code{1}.
  13146. @item data
  13147. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  13148. @item rotation
  13149. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  13150. Default value is @code{0}.
  13151. @end table
  13152. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  13153. section.
  13154. @subsection Examples
  13155. @itemize
  13156. @item
  13157. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  13158. @example
  13159. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  13160. @end example
  13161. @item
  13162. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  13163. @example
  13164. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  13165. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  13166. @end example
  13167. @end itemize
  13168. @section showspectrumpic
  13169. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  13170. spectrum.
  13171. The filter accepts the following options:
  13172. @table @option
  13173. @item size, s
  13174. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13175. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13176. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  13177. @item mode
  13178. Specify display mode.
  13179. It accepts the following values:
  13180. @table @samp
  13181. @item combined
  13182. all channels are displayed in the same row
  13183. @item separate
  13184. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  13185. @end table
  13186. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  13187. @item color
  13188. Specify display color mode.
  13189. It accepts the following values:
  13190. @table @samp
  13191. @item channel
  13192. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  13193. @item intensity
  13194. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  13195. @item rainbow
  13196. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  13197. @item moreland
  13198. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  13199. @item nebulae
  13200. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  13201. @item fire
  13202. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  13203. @item fiery
  13204. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  13205. @item fruit
  13206. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  13207. @item cool
  13208. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  13209. @end table
  13210. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  13211. @item scale
  13212. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  13213. It accepts the following values:
  13214. @table @samp
  13215. @item lin
  13216. linear
  13217. @item sqrt
  13218. square root, default
  13219. @item cbrt
  13220. cubic root
  13221. @item log
  13222. logarithmic
  13223. @item 4thrt
  13224. 4th root
  13225. @item 5thrt
  13226. 5th root
  13227. @end table
  13228. Default value is @samp{log}.
  13229. @item saturation
  13230. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  13231. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  13232. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  13233. Default value is @code{1}.
  13234. @item win_func
  13235. Set window function.
  13236. It accepts the following values:
  13237. @table @samp
  13238. @item rect
  13239. @item bartlett
  13240. @item hann
  13241. @item hanning
  13242. @item hamming
  13243. @item blackman
  13244. @item welch
  13245. @item flattop
  13246. @item bharris
  13247. @item bnuttall
  13248. @item bhann
  13249. @item sine
  13250. @item nuttall
  13251. @item lanczos
  13252. @item gauss
  13253. @item tukey
  13254. @item dolph
  13255. @item cauchy
  13256. @item parzen
  13257. @item poisson
  13258. @end table
  13259. Default value is @code{hann}.
  13260. @item orientation
  13261. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  13262. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13263. @item gain
  13264. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  13265. Default value is @code{1}.
  13266. @item legend
  13267. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  13268. @item rotation
  13269. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  13270. Default value is @code{0}.
  13271. @end table
  13272. @subsection Examples
  13273. @itemize
  13274. @item
  13275. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  13276. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  13277. @example
  13278. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  13279. @end example
  13280. @end itemize
  13281. @section showvolume
  13282. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  13283. The filter accepts the following options:
  13284. @table @option
  13285. @item rate, r
  13286. Set video rate.
  13287. @item b
  13288. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  13289. @item w
  13290. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  13291. @item h
  13292. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  13293. @item f
  13294. Set fade, allowed range is [0.001, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  13295. @item c
  13296. Set volume color expression.
  13297. The expression can use the following variables:
  13298. @table @option
  13299. @item VOLUME
  13300. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  13301. @item PEAK
  13302. Current peak.
  13303. @item CHANNEL
  13304. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  13305. @end table
  13306. @item t
  13307. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  13308. @item v
  13309. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  13310. @item o
  13311. Set orientation, can be @code{horizontal} or @code{vertical},
  13312. default is @code{horizontal}.
  13313. @item s
  13314. Set step size, allowed range s [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  13315. step is disabled.
  13316. @end table
  13317. @section showwaves
  13318. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  13319. The filter accepts the following options:
  13320. @table @option
  13321. @item size, s
  13322. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13323. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13324. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  13325. @item mode
  13326. Set display mode.
  13327. Available values are:
  13328. @table @samp
  13329. @item point
  13330. Draw a point for each sample.
  13331. @item line
  13332. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  13333. @item p2p
  13334. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  13335. @item cline
  13336. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  13337. @end table
  13338. Default value is @code{point}.
  13339. @item n
  13340. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  13341. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  13342. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  13343. is not explicitly specified.
  13344. @item rate, r
  13345. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  13346. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  13347. @item split_channels
  13348. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  13349. @item colors
  13350. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  13351. @item scale
  13352. Set amplitude scale.
  13353. Available values are:
  13354. @table @samp
  13355. @item lin
  13356. Linear.
  13357. @item log
  13358. Logarithmic.
  13359. @item sqrt
  13360. Square root.
  13361. @item cbrt
  13362. Cubic root.
  13363. @end table
  13364. Default is linear.
  13365. @end table
  13366. @subsection Examples
  13367. @itemize
  13368. @item
  13369. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  13370. at the same time:
  13371. @example
  13372. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  13373. @end example
  13374. @item
  13375. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  13376. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  13377. @example
  13378. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  13379. @end example
  13380. @end itemize
  13381. @section showwavespic
  13382. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  13383. The filter accepts the following options:
  13384. @table @option
  13385. @item size, s
  13386. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13387. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13388. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  13389. @item split_channels
  13390. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  13391. @item colors
  13392. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  13393. @item scale
  13394. Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
  13395. Default is linear.
  13396. @end table
  13397. @subsection Examples
  13398. @itemize
  13399. @item
  13400. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  13401. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  13402. @example
  13403. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  13404. @end example
  13405. @end itemize
  13406. @section spectrumsynth
  13407. Sythesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  13408. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  13409. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  13410. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  13411. This filter is primarly created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  13412. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  13413. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  13414. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  13415. its just recreated from random noise.
  13416. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  13417. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  13418. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  13419. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  13420. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  13421. The filter accepts the following options:
  13422. @table @option
  13423. @item sample_rate
  13424. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  13425. spectrum was generated may differ.
  13426. @item channels
  13427. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  13428. @item scale
  13429. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  13430. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  13431. @item slide
  13432. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  13433. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  13434. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  13435. @item win_func
  13436. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  13437. @item overlap
  13438. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  13439. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  13440. @item orientation
  13441. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  13442. Default is @code{vertical}.
  13443. @end table
  13444. @subsection Examples
  13445. @itemize
  13446. @item
  13447. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  13448. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  13449. @example
  13450. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  13451. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  13452. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  13453. @end example
  13454. @end itemize
  13455. @section split, asplit
  13456. Split input into several identical outputs.
  13457. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  13458. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  13459. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  13460. @subsection Examples
  13461. @itemize
  13462. @item
  13463. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  13464. @example
  13465. [in] split [out0][out1]
  13466. @end example
  13467. @item
  13468. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  13469. outputs, like in:
  13470. @example
  13471. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  13472. @end example
  13473. @item
  13474. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  13475. one padded:
  13476. @example
  13477. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  13478. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  13479. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  13480. @end example
  13481. @item
  13482. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13483. @example
  13484. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  13485. @end example
  13486. @end itemize
  13487. @section zmq, azmq
  13488. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  13489. filters in the filtergraph.
  13490. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  13491. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  13492. audio filters.
  13493. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  13494. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  13495. For more information about libzmq see:
  13496. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  13497. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  13498. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  13499. @option{bind_address} option.
  13500. The received message must be in the form:
  13501. @example
  13502. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  13503. @end example
  13504. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  13505. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  13506. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  13507. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  13508. given @var{COMMAND}.
  13509. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  13510. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  13511. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  13512. @example
  13513. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  13514. @var{MESSAGE}
  13515. @end example
  13516. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  13517. @subsection Examples
  13518. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  13519. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  13520. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}
  13521. @example
  13522. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  13523. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  13524. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  13525. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  13526. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  13527. [bg+l][r] overlay=x=100 "
  13528. @end example
  13529. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  13530. command can be used:
  13531. @example
  13532. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  13533. @end example
  13534. To change the right side:
  13535. @example
  13536. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  13537. @end example
  13538. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  13539. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  13540. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  13541. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  13542. @section amovie
  13543. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  13544. stream by default.
  13545. @anchor{movie}
  13546. @section movie
  13547. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  13548. It accepts the following parameters:
  13549. @table @option
  13550. @item filename
  13551. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  13552. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  13553. @item format_name, f
  13554. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  13555. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  13556. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  13557. @item seek_point, sp
  13558. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  13559. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  13560. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  13561. postfix. The default value is "0".
  13562. @item streams, s
  13563. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  13564. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  13565. same order. The syntax is explained in the ``Stream specifiers''
  13566. section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  13567. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  13568. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  13569. @item stream_index, si
  13570. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  13571. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  13572. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  13573. audio instead of video.
  13574. @item loop
  13575. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  13576. If the value is less than 1, the stream will be read again and again.
  13577. Default value is "1".
  13578. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  13579. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  13580. @item discontinuity
  13581. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  13582. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  13583. timestamps.
  13584. @end table
  13585. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  13586. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  13587. @example
  13588. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  13589. ^
  13590. |
  13591. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  13592. @end example
  13593. @subsection Examples
  13594. @itemize
  13595. @item
  13596. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  13597. on top of the input labelled "in":
  13598. @example
  13599. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  13600. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13601. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  13602. @end example
  13603. @item
  13604. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  13605. labelled "in":
  13606. @example
  13607. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  13608. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13609. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  13610. @end example
  13611. @item
  13612. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  13613. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  13614. connected to the pad named "audio":
  13615. @example
  13616. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  13617. @end example
  13618. @end itemize
  13619. @subsection Commands
  13620. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  13621. @table @option
  13622. @item seek
  13623. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  13624. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  13625. @itemize
  13626. @item
  13627. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  13628. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  13629. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  13630. @item
  13631. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  13632. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  13633. @item
  13634. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  13635. @end itemize
  13636. @item get_duration
  13637. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  13638. @end table
  13639. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES